Onkyo Stereo System TX NR1000 User Manual

Contents  
AV Receiver  
Getting Started  
2
TX-NR1000  
Installation and  
Connections  
18  
48  
TX-NR5000E  
Instruction Manual  
Operations  
Setup Menu  
82  
Using the Remote  
Controller  
124  
143  
Thank you for purchasing an Onkyo AV Receiver.  
Please read this manual thoroughly before making  
connections and plugging in the unit.  
Following the instructions in this manual will enable  
you to obtain optimum performance and listening  
enjoyment from your new AV Receiver.  
Miscellaneous  
Please retain this manual for future reference.  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Precautions  
1. Recording Copyright  
For U.S. Models  
Unless its for personal use only, recording copyrighted  
material is illegal without permission of the copyright  
holder.  
Note to CATV system installer:  
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installers  
attention to Section 820-40 of the NEC which provides guide-  
lines for proper grounding and, in particular, species that the  
cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the  
building, as close to the point of cable entry as practical.  
2. AC Fuse  
The AC fuse inside the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is not  
user-serviceable. If you cannot turn on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, contact your Onkyo dealer.  
3. Care  
FCC Information for User  
CAUTION:  
User changes or modications not expressly approved by the  
party responsible for compliance could void the users author-  
ity to operate the equipment.  
Occasionally you should dust the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E all over with a soft cloth. For stubborn  
stains, use a soft cloth dampened with a weak solution of  
mild detergent and water. Dry the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E immediately afterwards with a clean cloth.  
Dont use abrasive cloths, thinners, alcohol, or other  
chemical solvents, because they may damage the nish or  
remove the panel lettering.  
NOTE:  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits  
for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection  
against harmful interference in a residential installation.  
This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio fre-  
quency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance  
with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio  
communications. However, there is no guarantee that interfer-  
ence will not occur in a particular installation. If this equip-  
ment does cause harmful interference to radio or television  
reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment  
off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interfer-  
ence by one or more of the following measures:  
4. Power  
WARNING  
BEFORE PLUGGING IN THE UNIT FOR THE FIRST  
TIME, READ THE FOLLOWING SECTION CAREFULLY.  
AC outlet voltages vary from country to country. Make sure  
that the voltage in your area meets the voltage requirements  
printed on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es rear panel (e.g.,  
AC 230 V, 50 Hz or AC 120 V, 60 Hz).  
The Worldwide model has a voltage selector for compatibility  
with power systems around the world. Before you plug in this  
model, make sure that the voltage selector is set to the correct  
voltage for your area.  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and the  
receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from  
that to which the receiver is connected.  
For USA, Canadian, and Australian models  
Setting the [STANDBY/ON] switch to STANDBY does not  
fully shutdown the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. If you do not  
intend to use the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E for an extended  
period, remove the power cord from the AC outlet.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
For British Models  
Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the power supply  
cord of this unit should be performed only by qualied service  
personnel.  
For Canadian Models  
NOTE:  
THIS CLASS B DIGITAL APPARATUS COMPLIES WITH  
CANADIAN ICES-003.  
RSS 210, Low Power Licence-Exempt Radiocommunications  
Devices (All FrequencyBands).  
IMPORTANT  
The wires in the mains lead are coloured in accordance with  
For models having a power cord with a polarized plug:  
the following code:  
CAUTION:  
TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE BLADE  
OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.  
Blue: Neutral  
Brown: Live  
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus  
may not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the  
terminals in your plug, proceed as follows:  
The wire that is coloured blue must be connected to the termi-  
nal that is marked with the letter N or coloured black.  
The wire that is coloured brown must be connected to the ter-  
minal that is marked with the letter L or coloured red.  
IMPORTANT  
The plug is tted with an appropriate fuse. If the fuse needs to  
be replaced, the replacement fuse must be approved by ASTA  
or BSI to BS1362 and have the same ampere rating as that  
indicated on the plug. Check for the ASTA mark or the BSI  
mark on the body of the fuse.  
IF THE FITTED MOULDED PLUG IS UNSUITABLE FOR  
THE SOCKET OUTLET IN YOUR HOME THEN THE  
FUSE SHOULD BE REMOVED AND THE PLUG CUT OFF  
AND DISPOSED OF SAFELY. THERE IS A DANGER OF  
SEVERE ELECTRICAL SHOCK IF THE CUT OFF PLUG  
IS INSERTED INTO ANY 13 AMPERE SOCKET.  
If in any doubt, consult a qualied electrician.  
Modèle Canadien  
REMARQUE:  
CET APPAREIL NUMÉRIQUE DE LA CLASSE B EST  
CONFORME À LA NORME NMB-003 DU CANADA.  
CNR-210, Dispositifs de radiocommunications de faible  
puissance, exempts de licence (pour toutes les bandes de  
fréquences).  
Sur les modèles dont la che est polarisée:  
ATTENTION:  
POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLECTRIQUES, INTRODUIRE  
LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA  
BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER  
JUSQUAU FOND.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Connection Using HDMI Terminals............... 43  
Connecting Components not Reached by the  
Remote Controller Signals (IR IN/OUT)..... 45  
If Remote Controller Signal Does not Reach the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E Remote Sensor ....45  
If Remote Controller Signal Does not Reach  
Other Components..................................... 46  
Using an External Device with 12V Trigger  
Terminal....................................................... 46  
Getting Started  
Important Safety Instructions ..........................2  
Precautions........................................................3  
Features .............................................................6  
Supplied Accessories.......................................8  
Connecting the Supplied Power Cord .............8  
Before Using the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E .....9  
Installing the Batteries .....................................9  
Using the Remote Controller ...........................9  
Index Parts and Facilities ...............................10  
Front Panels ..................................................10  
Inner Panels ..................................................12  
Rear Panel.....................................................14  
Front Panel Display .......................................15  
Remote Controller (Amp Mode).....................16  
Connecting  
-compatible AV  
Components................................................ 47  
Connections for Remote Control (  
) ......... 47  
Operations  
Basic Operation of Remote Controller  
Buttons ........................................................ 48  
To Operate the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
(AMP Mode) ............................................... 48  
To Select an Input Source ............................ 48  
To Operate a Connected Component  
Installation and Connections  
Speaker Placement .........................................18  
Basic Speaker Placements for Home Theater  
and the Function of Respective Speakers......18  
Placing the Speakers.....................................19  
Speaker Placement Suitable for  
(Mode Switching)........................................ 49  
To Select a Source in Zone 2 or Zone 3....... 49  
To Perform a Macro Operation ..................... 49  
Customizing Your Remote Controller ........... 49  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations ..... 50  
Turning on the Power.................................... 50  
Operating on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E..... 50  
Turning on the Power from the Remote  
Controller.................................................... 51  
Operating with Remote Controller................. 51  
Using the Listening Modes............................ 56  
Selecting the Listening Mode........................ 59  
Listening to Radio Broadcasts...................... 60  
Using the Tuner ............................................ 60  
Tuning into a Radio Station........................... 60  
Listening to RDS Broadcasts  
(European models only)............................. 62  
Listening to RDS Broadcasts........................ 62  
PTY Program Types in Europe..................... 62  
Displaying Radio Text (RT)........................... 63  
Performing a PTY Scan ................................ 63  
Performing a TP Scan................................... 63  
Enjoying Multichannel Playback................... 64  
How to Connect ............................................ 64  
How to Set Up............................................... 64  
Playing Back in Multichannel Sound............. 65  
Adjusting the Volume Level of Speakers for  
Multichannel Playback................................ 65  
Enjoying Movies and Music in the Remote  
Zone (Zone 2/3) ........................................... 66  
Connecting and Setup .................................. 66  
Enjoying Movies and Music in a Remote  
Zone ........................................................... 67  
Recording a Source........................................ 69  
Recording Audio/Video While Playing .......... 70  
Recording Audio/Video on a Component While  
Playing Another.......................................... 70  
Recording the Video from One Source and the  
Audio from Another Source........................ 71  
Enjoying Net Audio......................................... 72  
About Net-Tune............................................. 72  
Networking Your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E..... 73  
THX Audio...................................................20  
Speaker Placement Suitable for  
a Music Source such as DVD-Audio...........20  
Available Speaker Placements According to  
the Number of Speakers.............................21  
Connection Examples....................................22  
Connecting Speakers......................................25  
Connecting to the Speaker Terminals ...........25  
Connecting a Subwoofer ...............................26  
Connecting Auxiliary Power Amplifier  
(For Speaker System [A] only)....................26  
Using the BTL Connection.............................27  
Using Bi-amp Connection..............................27  
Connecting Antennas .....................................28  
Connecting the Indoor FM Antenna...............28  
Connecting the AM Loop Antenna.................28  
Connecting an Outdoor FM Antenna.............29  
Connecting an Outdoor AM Antenna.............29  
Connecting AV Components..........................30  
Types of Connection Cables and  
Terminals ....................................................30  
Connecting Monitors such as TV or  
Projector......................................................32  
Connecting a DVD Player..............................33  
Connecting a DVD Recorder or Digital VCR  
(VIDEO 1)....................................................34  
Connecting a VCR (VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3).......35  
Connecting a DBS Tuner, DBS TV, or  
BS/CS Tuner...............................................37  
Connecting a Portable DVD Player or  
Video Camcorder ........................................38  
Connecting a CD Player, Turntable or  
Tuner...........................................................38  
Connecting a Recording Device such as  
MD Recorder, DAT Deck, CD Recorder or  
Cassette Deck.............................................39  
Connection Using the i.LINK (AUDIO)  
Terminal ( )..............................................40  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents—Continued  
About Network Configuration ........................73  
Using the Remote Controller.........................74  
Enjoying Internet Radio.................................76  
Playing a Music File Saved on the Net-Tune  
Server.........................................................78  
Configuring the Music Server........................80  
Audio Adjust..................................................118  
Tone Control Sub-menu ..............................118  
Preferences....................................................119  
Volume Setup Sub-menu ............................119  
Headphone Level Setup Sub-menu ............119  
OSD Setup Sub-menu.................................119  
OSD Position Sub-menu ............................119  
i.LINK Setup...................................................120  
Wakeup Setup.............................................120  
OSD for DVD...............................................120  
OSD for DVD (Zone 2) ................................120  
DVD Output Synchro...................................120  
Network Setup ...............................................121  
IP Address Sub-menu ................................121  
Proxy Sub-menu.........................................121  
MAC Address Sub-menu.............................121  
Client Sub-menu..........................................122  
Lock/Version Setup.......................................123  
Lock Setup Sub-menu.................................123  
Firmware Version Sub-menu.......................123  
Setup Menu  
Setup Menu......................................................82  
OSD Map (MAIN A).......................................82  
OSD Map (MAIN B).......................................84  
OSD Map (ZONE 2)......................................85  
Navigating the Setup Menu...........................86  
Hardware Setup...............................................87  
Remote Control Setup Sub-menu.................87  
TV Format Sub-menu....................................87  
AM Frequency Setup Sub-menu  
(Asian and Australian Models Only) ...........87  
Speaker/Output Setup ....................................88  
Speaker Configuration Sub-menu.................88  
Speaker Impedance Sub-menu ....................89  
Speaker Crossover Sub-menu......................89  
Speaker Distance Sub-menu ........................89  
Notch Filter Sub-menu ..................................90  
Level Calibration Sub-menu..........................90  
THX Audio Setup Sub-menu.........................91  
Audio Output Assign Sub-menu....................91  
Video Output Assign Sub-menu....................92  
Input Setup ......................................................93  
Audio Assign Sub-menu (when input is other  
than NET AUDIO).......................................94  
Music Server Sub-menu (When input is NET  
AUDIO).......................................................95  
Video Assign Sub-menu................................95  
Listening Mode Preset Sub-menu.................96  
Character Edit Sub-menu..............................97  
IntelliVolume Sub-menu................................98  
Delay Sub-menu ...........................................98  
12V Trigger Assign Sub-menu......................98  
Listening Mode Setup.....................................99  
Mono Setup Sub-menu .................................99  
Multiplex Setup Sub-menu............................99  
Stereo Setup Sub-menu..............................100  
Direct, Pure Audio Setup Sub-menu...........101  
Multichannel Input Setup Sub-menu...........102  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio Input Setup  
Using the Remote Controller  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote  
Controller ...................................................124  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the  
Connection................................................124  
DVD Mode...................................................124  
CD Mode .....................................................126  
MiniDisc Mode.............................................127  
Tape Mode ..................................................128  
Using the Remote Controller with Other  
Components...............................................129  
Entering a Remote Control Code ................129  
Learning Commands from Another Remote  
Controller ..................................................136  
Using Macros...............................................137  
Other Settings for the Remote Controller...139  
Editing Remote Controller Modes................139  
Resetting the Remote Controller .................141  
Using the Remote Controller with Radio  
Frequency (RC-558M only).......................141  
Changing the Remote Controller’s  
Control ID..................................................142  
Miscellaneous  
Sub-menu.................................................103  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD Input Setup  
Relationship Between Input Source and  
Sub-menu.................................................105  
Dolby Digital Setup Sub-menu....................106  
DTS Setup Sub-menu.................................108  
AAC Setup Sub-menu.................................109  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx/DTS NEO:6 (2ch Input only)  
Setup Sub-menu.......................................110  
THX Setup Sub-menu.................................112  
Mono Movie Setup/Enhance Setup/Orchestra  
Setup/Unplugged Setup/Studio-Mix Setup/TV  
Logic Setup Sub-menu.............................114  
All Ch Stereo Setup/Full Mono Setup  
Listening Mode ..........................................143  
Troubleshooting............................................146  
Power ..........................................................146  
Audio ...........................................................146  
Video ...........................................................147  
Tuner ...........................................................147  
Remote Controller .......................................147  
Recording ....................................................148  
Zone 2/Zone 3 .............................................148  
Net-Tune......................................................148  
Others..........................................................148  
Error Messages ...........................................149  
Specifications................................................150  
Sub-menu.................................................115  
Dolby Virtual Speaker Setup Sub-menu .....116  
Dolby Headphone Setup Sub-menu ...........117  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features  
Amplifier Features  
Next Generation User Interface  
192 kHz/24-Bit DAC for All Channels  
• Color-Coded Heavy Duty Dual Banana Plug  
Compatible Transparent Speaker Posts  
Color-Coded 7.1 Multi-Channel Inputs and Pre  
Outs  
• HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface)  
• i.Link (IEEE1394) Digital Input for DVD-Audio  
and SACD  
• Net-Tune Function with MP3/WAV/WMA  
Decoding  
• Powered Zone 2 and Zone 3  
• 5 12V DC Trigger Outputs and 3 IR Inputs/  
Outputs  
• Ethernet Plug-In Capability and 1 Output  
• Bi-Directional RS-232 Port to download new  
programs and provide easy interface with  
touchscreen controllers from other manufacturers  
• Composite and S Video to Component Video  
Upconversion (NTSC and PAL Compatible)  
• Speaker A and B Mode for 7.1 Channels  
• BTL and Bi-Wiring Connectable for FL/FR with  
SBR/SBL  
Massive, Shielded Toroidal Transformer, the kind  
you find only in the best high end audio equipment, to  
provide copious amounts of pure current  
Huge Custom Designed Audio Tuned Reference  
Capacitors to deliver greater power at low  
frequencies, and provide tremendous continuous  
power reserves during the most dynamic sound  
effects and music demands  
• Dual 32-Bit DSP Chips for high grade main and  
multizone decoding  
Powerful Transistors. These high power, high  
quality transistors are ready to amplify your electrical  
signals for the highest performance possible  
High Grade Dual Aluminum Extruded Heatsinks  
and auto-switched cooling fan to keep things cool  
when the action gets hot  
5 12V DC Trigger Outputs and 3 IR Inputs/  
Outputs for multizone operation of multiple  
components  
• Individual Crossover Adjustment  
FM/AM Tuner Features  
• WRAT (Wide Range Amplifier Technology)  
• Optimum Gain Volume Circuitry  
• 40 FM/AM Presets  
• FM/AM Auto Tuning  
Audio/Video Features  
Other Performance Features  
• THX Ultra2 Certified  
• VLSC (Vector Linear Shaping Circuitry)  
Solid Aluminum Volume Knob for quality you can  
feel—ergonomically pleasing and convenient for  
those quick in-the-dark level changes  
Separate PC Boards to keep audio and video signals  
completely separate  
• THX Surround EX, DTS-ES Discrete/Matrix 6.1,  
DTS NEO:6, DTS 96/24, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby  
Pro Logic II/IIx, Dolby Headphone, Dolby Virtual  
Surround  
• 4 Wideband Component Video Inputs and 2  
Outputs  
Dual Monitor Outputs (S Video/Composite) to  
route the onscreen signal to a small monitor and make  
adjustments without distracting the audience  
13 Digital Inputs (1 Optical on Front) (7 Optical/6  
Coaxial/12 Assignable) to connect any variety of  
digital sources to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E’s  
powerful digital processor  
4 Digital Outputs (2 Optical/2 Coaxial/4Assignable)  
to make direct digital dubs to other digital devices  
Wolfson 192 kHz/24-Bit D/A Converters for all  
channels  
Rec Out Selector (On Front) to tape one program  
while watching or listening to another  
Gold-Plated RCA Jacks to resist corrosion and  
provide distortion-free signal transmission  
2 Sets of Color-Coded Heavy Duty, Transparent,  
Dual-Banana-Plug Speaker Terminals for all  
channels to provide distortion-free signal transfer and  
accommodate heavy gauge speaker cable  
Impeccable Quality Materials —a heavy gauge,  
reinforced steel chassis, rigid aluminum panels and  
brazen stabilizers to enhance overall chassis stability  
Large Multi-Emitter Output Transistors to provide  
faster switching speed, which translates into a wider  
dynamic range  
Dual 32-Bit DSP Chips for high grade main and  
multizone decoding  
• Non-Scaling Configuration  
Zone 2 Multiroom/Multisource (audio and video) to  
set up additional rooms  
Detachable Heavy Duty IEC Power Cord to  
minimize interference from external sources and  
increase power stability—detachable for ease of  
installation  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features—Continued  
THX is a trademark or registered trademark of THX Ltd.  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High Definition Multimedia  
Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing, LLC.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
“Dolby,” “Pro Logic,” “Surround EX,” and the double-D symbol  
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.  
“DTS,” “DTS 96/24,” “DTS-ES,” and “NEO:6” are trademarks  
of Digital Theater Systems, Inc.  
The i.LINK logo is a trademark of Sony Corporation, registered  
in the U.S. and other countries.  
• Audiophile Grade Parts  
• IntelliVolume  
• Pure Audio Mode  
• Digital Upsampling  
• Absolute Ground Plate  
• Large, Fluorescent, 35 Dot Matrix Display With 4  
Mode Dimmer  
• For Ultimate Control—The Last Remote You’ll  
Ever Need  
• A-Form Listening Mode Memory  
In catalogs and on packaging, the letter added to the end  
of the product name indicates the color of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. Specifications and  
operation are the same regardless of color.  
Re-Equalization and the “Re-EQ” logo are trademarks of THX Ltd.  
“Net-Tune” is a trademark of Onkyo Corporation.  
Windows Media and the Windows logo are trandemarks, or  
registered trademarks of  
Microsoft Corporation in the  
United States and/or other  
countries.  
Intel and Pentium are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation.  
MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from  
Fraunhofer IIS and THOMSON multimedia.  
Xantech is a registered trademark of Xantech Corporation.  
Niles is a registered trademark of Niles Audio Corporation.  
“This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is  
protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use  
of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for home and other  
limited consumer uses only unless otherwise authorized by  
Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited.”  
THX Ultra2  
Before any home theater component can be THX Ultra2 certified, it  
must pass a rigorous series of quality and performance tests. Only  
then can a product feature the THX Ultra2 logo, which is your  
guarantee that the Home Theater products you purchase will give  
you superb performance for many years to come. THX Ultra2  
requirements define hundreds of parameters, including power  
amplifier performance, and pre-amplifier performance and  
operation for both digital and analog domains. THX Ultra2  
receivers also feature proprietary THX technologies (e.g., THX  
Mode) which accurately translate film soundtracks for home theater  
playback.  
For European Models  
Declaration of Conformity  
We,  
ONKYO EUROPE  
ELECTRONICS GmbH  
LIEGNITZERSTRASSE 6,  
82194 GROEBENZELL,  
GERMANY  
declare in own responsibility, that the ONKYO product  
described in this instruction manual is in compliance with the  
corresponding  
technical standards such as EN60065,  
EN55013, EN55020 and EN61000-3-2, -3-3.  
GROEBENZELL, GERMANY  
I. MORI  
ONKYO EUROPE ELECTRONICS GmbH  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplied Accessories  
Make sure you have the following accessories:  
Remote Controller & Three Batteries (AA/R6)  
Power Cord  
Connecting the Supplied Power Cord  
Plug the supplied power cord into this AC INLET.  
Do not use a power cord other than the one supplied  
with the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The power cord  
supplied is designed for use with the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E and should not be used with any other  
device.  
AM Loop Antenna (not supplied with USA and Cana-  
dian models)  
Never have the power cord disconnected from the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E while the other end is  
plugged into the wall outlet. Doing so may cause an  
electric shock. Always connect by plugging into the  
wall outlet last and disconnect by unplugging from  
the wall outlet rst.  
Indoor FM antenna (not supplied with USA and  
Canadian models)  
(connector type varies from country to country)  
1
2
3
Power Cord  
Speaker Cable  
(supplied)  
AC INLET  
Speaker Labels  
DO NOT connect the  
power cord at this time.  
Terminal Wrench  
A wrench to screw/unscrew the speaker terminal cap.  
Power Plug adapter  
Only supplied in certain countries. Use this adapter if  
your AC outlet does not match the plug on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E’s power cord (adapter varies  
from country to country).  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before Using the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Installing the Batteries  
Using the Remote Controller  
To use the remote controller, point it at the  
To open the battery compartment, press  
the small hollow and slide off the cover.  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote control sensor, as  
shown below. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es  
[STANDBY] indicator ashes while a signal is being  
received from the remote controller.  
1
Remote control sensor  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
STANDBY indicator  
Insert the three supplied batteries (AA/R6)  
2
in accordance with the polarity diagram  
inside the battery compartment.  
30˚  
30˚  
Notes:  
The remote controller may not work reliably if the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is subjected to bright  
light, such as direct sunlight or inverter-type  
uorescent lights. Keep this in mind when installing  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Put the cover onto the remote controller  
and slide it shut.  
3
If another remote controller of the same type is used  
in the same room, or the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
is installed close to equipment that uses infrared rays,  
the remote controller may not work reliably.  
Dont put anything, such as a book, on the remote  
controller, because the buttons may be pressed  
inadvertently, thereby draining the batteries.  
The remote controller may not work reliably if the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is installed in a rack  
behind colored glass doors. Keep this in mind when  
installing the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
The remote controller will not work if theres an  
obstacle between it and the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es remote control sensor.  
(RC-558M only) You can set the transmission signal  
format to infrared (IR), or radio frequency (RF) for  
use with the optional RF Receiver. This is useful  
when, for example, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is  
installed in a rack or is not in line of sight of the  
remote controller.  
Notes:  
The supplied batteries should last for about six  
months, although this will vary with usage.  
If the remote controller doesnt work reliably, try  
replacing the batteries.  
Dont mix new and old batteries, or different types of  
batteries.  
If you intend not to use the remote controller for a  
long time, remove the batteries to prevent possible  
leakage and corrosion.  
Expired batteries should be removed as soon as  
possible to prevent damage from leakage or  
corrosion.  
To select AMP mode, press the scroll wheel. AMP”  
appears on the display.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities  
Here is an explanation of the controls and displays on the front panel of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
The specications for your model may differ due to regional requirements.  
Front Panels  
USA, Canadian, and Australian models  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
CD  
NET AUDIO  
(
)
REC/ZONE  
3
RED  
MAIN  
(
BLUE)  
(
)
ZONE  
2
GREEN  
OPEN  
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
PURE AUDIO  
European models  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
POWER  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
CD  
NET AUDIO  
(
)
REC/ZONE  
3
RED  
MAIN  
(
BLUE)  
(
)
ZONE  
2
GREEN  
OPEN  
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
ON  
OFF  
PURE AUDIO  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
For further operational instructions, see the pages  
indicated in brackets [ ].  
1POWER switch (for all models other than  
USA, Canadian, and Australian models) [50]  
Press to turn on and off the main power supply for  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. When the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is turned on with the  
[POWER] switch, the [STANDBY] indicator lights.  
Before turning on the power, check to make sure  
that all cords are properly connected.  
When the power is turned on, a sudden surge of  
current will occur that may adversely affect the  
operation of other devices. To prevent this, do not  
plug the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E into the same  
circuit used by sensitive equipment, e.g., computers.  
2STANDBY indicator [9, 50]  
Lights when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is in  
the standby state and when a signal is received from  
the remote controller.  
3STANDBY/ON button [50]  
If pressed with the [POWER] switch turned on (with  
the receiver plugged in for USA, Canadian, and  
Australian models), the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
turns on and the display lights up. If pressed again, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E returns to the standby  
state. In the standby state, the display is turned off and  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E cannot be operated.  
4Remote control sensor [9]  
5DISPLAY button [54]  
Press to display information about the current input  
source signal. Each time you press the [DISPLAY]  
button, the screen changes to show you different  
information concerning the input signal.  
6Front display  
7Input source buttons and indicators (DVD,  
VIDEO 1–7,TAPE 1-2,TUNER, PHONO, CD,  
and NET AUDIO) [50, 60, 63, 76]  
Press these buttons to select the input source for the  
main zone.  
After selecting the input source, the corresponding  
indicator turns blue. If you select Zone 2, the  
indicator turns green. If you select Zone 3 or Rec,  
the indicator turns red.  
8MASTER VOLUME dial [50]  
Use to control the volume in the main zone. The  
volume for the remote zone (Zone 2 and Zone 3) is  
independent.  
9OPEN button  
Press this button to open the front panel door.  
0PURE AUDIO indicator [59]  
Lights during pure audio playback.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
Inner Panels  
USA, Canadian, and Australian models  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
European models  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
7
INPUT  
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
L
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
RT/PTY/TP  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
ALISTENING MODE button [59]  
Press this button to enter the setup mode for the  
listening mode. Turning the [SELECT/PRESET]  
allows you to select the listening mode. To conrm  
your selection and exit the setup mode, press the  
[SELECT/PRESET].  
JEXIT button [86]  
Press this button to return to the last menu. To exit  
from the setup mode, press the [SETUP] button again.  
KSELECT/PRESET dial [59, 61, 63, 68, 71, 86]  
When the input source is FM or AM, turning this  
jog dial allows you to switch between your preset  
stations. When used with other buttons, the  
BAUDIO SELECTOR button [55]  
Press this button to enter the audio selector mode.  
Turning the [SELECT/PRESET] allows you to  
select the audio mode.  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial is used to select the mode  
settings or parameters. Also the dial is pressed to  
conrm the settings or parameters you select.  
CTONE button [52]  
LZONE 2 LEVEL button [68]  
Pressing this button enters the volume adjustment  
mode for Zone 2. To adjust volume, turn the  
[SELECT/PRESET].  
Press this button to enter the tone adjustment mode.  
Turning the [SELECT/PRESET] allows you to  
select the channel to adjust the tone. To adjust the  
tone level, turn the [CONTROL/TUNING].  
MDIMMER button (Other than European  
models) [52]  
DZONE 2 button [68]  
Press this button to enter the Zone 2 conguration  
mode. Turning the [SELECT/PRESET] allows you  
to select the input source for Zone 2. Also, if you  
want to congure other Zone 2 settings such as  
standby/on setting, listening mode, volume  
adjustment, audio selector mode, and display  
settings, press this button rst.  
Press to set the brightness of the front display. There are  
four settings available: normal, dark, very dark, and  
volume only.  
For European models, this function can be operated  
only with the remote controller.  
MRT/PTY/TP button (European models only) [63]  
This button is only available on European models.  
Press this button to tune into the Radio Data System  
(RDS) for FM broadcasting. RDS was developed  
within the European Broadcasting Union (EBU)  
and is available in most European countries. Each  
time the button is pressed, the display changes from  
RT (radio text) to PTY (program type) to TP (trafc  
program) and then back to RT again.  
EREC/ZONE 3 button [68, 70]  
Press this button to enter the Rec/Zone 3 mode.  
Turning the [CONTROL/TUNING] allows you to  
select the input source for the Rec mode or Zone 3.  
Also, if you want to congure the setting for Zone 3  
including standby/on setting or volume adjustment,  
press this button rst.  
Note:  
NMEMORY button [61]  
Recording and Zone 3 operations uses the same  
circuit and therefore cannot be used at the same  
time.  
Press to assign the radio station, to which you are  
currently tuned, as a preset channel or press to  
delete a previously preset station.  
FVIDEO 7 INPUT terminals  
OTUNING MODE button [60, 61]  
This button is used to select the Auto or Manual  
Tuning Mode.  
For connecting a video camera or game device.  
GZONE 3 LEVEL button [68]  
Press this button to enter the volume adjustment  
mode for Zone 3. Turning the [SELECT/PRESET]  
allows you to adjust the volume.  
PPHONES jack [52]  
This is a standard stereo jack for connecting stereo  
headphones.  
HCONTROL/TUNING dial [52, 60, 68, 70, 86]  
When the input source is FM or AM, turning this jog  
dial allows you to select the frequency to receive.  
When used with other buttons, this [CONTROL/  
TUNING] dial is used to select the mode settings or  
values. Also the dial is pressed to conrm the  
settings or values you select.  
ISETUP button [86]  
Press this button to enter the setup mode. First,  
select the parameter to change by turning the  
[SELECT/PRESET] and press the [SELECT/  
PRESET] to conrm the parameter. Then, change  
the parameter value by turning the [CONTROL/  
TUNING] and press the [CONTROL/TUNING] to  
conrm the value.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
Rear Panel  
*
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
A
B
C
D
1
E
AUDIO IN  
L
H
I
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
S
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
P
B
R
GND  
P
B
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
P
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
P
R
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
Y
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
P
P
B
R
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
P
B
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
P
R
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
-INCH2  
IN  
OUT  
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
L
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
(
)
SINGLE  
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
B
SPEAKERS  
SPEAKERS  
A
B
L
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
R
SUB  
SUB  
CENTER  
(
)
(
)
BTL  
FRONT  
R
BTL  
FRONT  
L
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
UDC/UDT  
-
MODEL NO. TX NR1000  
OUT  
B
*This terminal is provided for future service enhancement and is not used currently. Never plug the cable connector for  
other terminals into this terminal.  
7VIDEO/S VIDEO IN/OUT  
1( ) i.LINK S400 (AUDIO) terminals  
Some of the Asian models are not equipped with the  
i.LINK(AUDIO) terminals.  
These connectors are for connecting to the video  
input and output jacks on video components.  
Six input and 4 output jacks are available for each  
of VIDEO and S VIDEO connection.  
These connectors are for connecting to the i.LINK  
(AUDIO)-ready device using a 4-pin (S400) i.LINK  
(AUDIO) cable. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
complies with the standards on audio only  
transimissions.  
8COMPONENT VIDEO IN/OUT  
These connectors are for connecting to the component  
video outputs/inputs of video components that have them.  
European and Asian models are equipped with three  
inputs and one output for the RCA-type  
COMPONENT connection and one input and  
output for the BNC-type COMPONENT  
connection.  
For other than European and Asian models, there  
are four inputs and two outputs for the RCA-type  
COMPONENT connection.  
2ETHERNET (Net-Tune)  
This connector is for connecting to an Ethernet network.  
3DIGITAL OPTICAL IN/OUT  
The input/output terminals for digital sound signal.  
The sound quality equals the signal passed through  
the COAXIAL terminals.  
4DIGITAL COAXIAL IN/OUT  
The input/output terminals for digital sound signal.  
The sound quality equals the signal passed through  
the OPTICAL terminals.  
Check the type of terminals or jacks on the device to  
connect before making connections.  
9ANTENNA (FM/AM)  
5MULTI-CH IN 1/2  
These jacks are for connecting the FM indoor  
antenna and the AM loop antenna that are supplied  
with the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
This connector is for connecting components with a  
multichannel output.  
Two sets of multichannel input terminals are  
available on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
0HDMI IN/OUT  
This interface can transfer digital audio and video  
signals simultaneously. The terminal can be  
connected to the HDMI terminal on the components  
such as DVD player, set top box (B tuner),  
projector, and digital TV.  
6AUDIO IN/OUT  
These connectors are for connecting to the audio  
input and output jacks on audio/video components.  
To connect a turntable, connect to the PH jacks.  
In addition to the PH jacks, the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E offers nine input and ve output jacks.  
A
REMOTE CONTROL  
This jack is for connecting other Onkyo components  
equipped with the same  
terminal. The audio  
connection cables must also be connected.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
device together with the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
The shape, number, and total capacity of the AC  
outlets may differ depending on the area of  
purchase.  
BRS 232  
This port is for connecting the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E to home automation and external  
controllers.  
CPRE OUT A/B  
To use the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E as a  
preamplier, connect a power amplier to this jack.  
Caution:  
Make sure that the total capacity of the components  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E does  
not exceed the capacity that is printed on the rear  
panel (e.g., AC 120V - 60Hz SWITCHED 120W  
1A MAX.).  
DSPEAKERS A/B  
These terminals are for connecting the speakers.  
Two sets of home theater connections are available  
(simultaneous playback of different sources in each  
of two home theaters is not supported).  
Depending on your system, various speaker  
connections will be available. For example, you can  
use the surround back speakers for playback in a  
different room.  
FAC INLET  
This connector is for connecting the supplied power  
cord.  
GIR IN/OUT  
These connectors are for connecting the remote  
sensor of a multiroom kit (sold separately).  
The connectors are provided for main room, Zone 2,  
and Zone 3.  
EAC OUTLET  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is equipped with  
AC mains outlets for connecting the power cords  
from other devices so that their power is supplied  
through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. By doing  
this, you can leave the connected device turned on  
and have the [STANDBY/ON] button on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E turn on and off the  
H12V TRIGGER OUT  
These connectors are used to connect to the 12V  
TRIGGER IN terminal of a component. Available  
connectors are one with maximum current capacity  
of 200 mA and four with 100 mA.  
Front Panel Display  
RDS indicator (European models only)  
Lights when an RDS station is being received.  
TUNED indicator  
Lights when a radio station is being received.  
MEMORY indicator  
Lights when the [MEMORY] button is pressed to  
preset a radio station.  
FM STEREO indicator  
Lights when an FM broadcast station is being  
received in stereo. Turns off when placed into the  
monaural mode.  
A Listening mode or input format indicators  
One of these indicators lights to show the format of  
the current input source. In addition, one of the  
listening mode indicators lights to indicate the  
current listening mode.  
B Multifunction display  
During normal operation, shows the current input  
source. When the FM or AM input is selected,  
shows the frequency and preset number. When the  
[DISPLAY] button is pressed, shows the listening  
mode and input source format.  
G Program format display  
C Audio input signal path indicators  
Shows from which terminal the audio input signal is  
coming.  
When the input source is DVD video, Super Audio  
CD, or compressed digital audio signal such as  
Dolby Digital and DTS, the channels corresponding  
to the input source light.  
D MAIN A/B indicators  
Indicates which room is currently in use.  
H Volume display  
E SLEEP indicator  
Shows the volume level.  
Lights when the sleep timer is turned on.  
I
Video input signal path indicators  
Shows from which terminal the video input signal is  
coming.  
F Tuning indicators  
AUTO indicator  
Lights when receiving FM broadcasts in the stereo  
mode. Turns off when placed into the monaural mode.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
Amp mode is used to control the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. To select Amp mode, press the scroll  
wheel. “AMP” appears on the display.  
Remote Controller (Amp Mode)  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote controller is a  
multipurpose device that can be used to control not just  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E but your other AV  
components as well. This section explains how its  
various operating modes can be used to control the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. When you use the Net-  
Tune mode, see page 74 for details. See page 124-136  
for information on using the remote controller to control  
Note:  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor the [MODE]  
button is illuminated, rolling the scroll wheel changes  
the input source and remote controller mode  
simultaneously.  
1ON button  
This button is used to turn on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Onkyo components connected via  
and TVs, VCRs,  
and AV components made by other manufacturers.  
2STANDBY button  
Scroll wheel  
This button is used to set the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E to Standby.  
3Number/letter buttons  
These buttons are used to enter numbers and letters.  
4CUSTOM button  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
TV  
This button is used to access various settings that  
you can use to customize the operation of the  
remote controller.  
I
INPUT  
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
5MACRO button  
4
5
6
This button is used with the Macro function.  
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
6MODE button  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
the remote controller modes.  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
10  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
7DIMMER button  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
This button is used to adjust the display brightness.  
MACRO  
8Up/Down/Left/Right [ ]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ] &  
ENTER buttons  
MODE  
INPUT  
These buttons are used to select items on the  
onscreen setup menus (OSD). The [ENTER] button  
is also used to enter names and to conrm settings.  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
9CH +/button  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
This button is used to select radio presets.  
-
0RETURN button  
PREV  
CH  
This button is used to return to the previously  
displayed onscreen setup menu (OSD).  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
ADISPLAY button  
This button is used to display various information  
about the currently selected input source.  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
BMAIN A button  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
For the speakers used in main room A, every press  
of this button toggles the status between enabled  
and disabled.  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
REPEAT  
PURE A  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
CTHX button  
-
+
TEST T  
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
This button is used to select the THX listening  
modes.  
-
L NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
DSURR button  
This button is used to select the Dolby and DTS  
listening modes.  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index Parts and Facilities—Continued  
EDIRECT button  
SMAIN B button  
This button is used to select the Direct listening  
mode.  
For the speakers used in main room B, every press  
of this button toggles the status between enabled  
and disabled.  
FPURE A button  
TAll ST button  
This button is used to select the Pure Audio listen-  
ing mode.  
This button is used to select the All Ch Stereo  
listening mode.  
GTEST TONE, CH SEL, LEVEL& LEVEL+  
buttons  
USTEREO button  
These buttons are used to adjust the level of each  
speaker individually. These functions can be set  
only with the remote controller. The [LEVEL] and  
[LEVEL+] buttons are also used to adjust the  
volume in Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
This button is used to select the Stereo listening  
mode.  
V
DSP/DSP  
buttons  
These buttons are used to select the listening modes.  
WRe-EQ button  
HAUDIO SEL button  
This button is used to turn on and off the Re-EQ  
function.  
This button is used to select the audio input signal  
format: analog, digital, multichannel, or i.LINK.  
XL NIGHT button  
ILIGHT button  
This button is used to set the Late Night function.  
This button is used to turn on or off the remote con-  
trollers illuminated buttons.  
JDIRECT TUNING button  
This button is used with the number buttons to  
select a radio station by entering its frequency. Press  
this button rst, and then use the number buttons to  
enter the frequency.  
KDisplay  
The top line of this LCD display shows the name of  
the currently selected input source. The bottom line  
shows the currently selected remote controller  
mode.  
LZONE 3 button  
This button is used when you want to set the volume  
and input source for Zone 3.  
MZONE 2 button  
This button is used when you want to set the volume  
and input source for Zone 2.  
NINPUT button  
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
the name of the input source appears on the display.  
OSLEEP button  
This button is used to set the Sleep function. This  
function can be set only with the remote controller.  
PVOL  
button  
This button is used to set the volume of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
QSETUP button  
This button is used to access the onscreen setup  
menus (OSD) that appear on the TV.  
RMUTING button  
This button is used to mute the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This function can be set only with  
the remote controller.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement  
Basic Speaker Placements for Home Theater and the Function of Respective  
Speakers  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E has many excellent features to recreate a clear three-dimensional sound image and lively  
sound movement. This enables you to enjoy, at home, the rich sound effects of a live theater or concert hall performance.  
When playing a DVD, you can enjoy sound effects provided by DTS or Dolby Digital, depending on recording format.  
In addition, you can enjoy THX sound and Onkyos proprietary DSP surround playback for TV or digital satellite  
broadcasts.  
Front left and right speakers  
Outputs overall sound. They play the most important role in a home  
theater system, by creating basic sound images and elds.  
Center speaker  
Complements the sound effects from front left and right speakers  
to enrich and clear the sound image and movement. In movies, an  
actors speech comes mainly from the center speaker.  
Surround back speakers  
Enhances the sound space  
representation with  
surround channel signals.  
Recreating sound  
movement effects and  
sound elds behind the  
listener gives a more  
realistic experience.  
Subwoofer  
Outputs only bass sounds to  
enhance and complement bass  
sound effects.  
Surround left and right speakers  
Enhances the sensation of being at a live performance by giving three-dimensional  
sound movement to the sound effects.  
• For optimum surround playback, set the distance between the listener and the speakers so that the time it takes  
the sound to reach the listener is same. Also, you need to set each speaker volume level individually in order to  
balance the volume level between speakers (See pages 88 and 90).  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
Placing the Speakers  
To fully enjoy surround sound, the conguration and placement of the speakers used are important. Be sure to read  
through the descriptions in the previous page and shown below.  
This section provides the examples and descriptions that assume a typical situation.  
Front Left and Right Speakers, and Center Speaker  
Place the front left and right speakers symmetrically and so  
that the distance from the listening position is the same.  
TV or screen  
When placing speakers, direct the speakers toward the  
position of the listeners ears where the listener sits to enjoy  
music or movies.  
Front  
Left  
Front  
Right  
Center  
TV  
Place the three speakers so that the heights of the three  
speakers are aligned. The ideal height for the speakers is the  
height of the listeners ears. When placing the center  
speaker above or below the TV, tilt it toward the listeners  
ears.  
Place the center speaker as close to the screen or monitor as  
possible and in the center between the left and right front  
speakers. When placing the center speaker near the TV, use a shielded speaker.  
If no center speaker is used, place the left and right front speakers closer to each other.  
Left and Right Surround Speakers  
Place these speakers on each side of, or angled behind, the  
listener.  
Place the surround speakers symmetrically from the listener  
position and so that the distance from the listener is equal  
between left and right surround speakers.  
When enjoying mainly movies, placing the surround  
speakers about 3 feet (1 m) higher than the height of the  
listeners ears, results in more of a surround effect.  
When enjoying mainly music, placing the surround  
Surround Back  
speakers at the height of the front speakers may provide a  
better surround effect.  
When using surround back speakers in addition to the  
surround speakers, placing the surround speakers slightly forward from their current position will make the sound  
movement smoother.  
Surround Back Speakers  
Place the speakers about 3 feet (1 m) or higher than the  
height of the listeners ears.  
When using one surround back speaker, place it behind the  
listener.  
When using two surround back speakers, place them  
behind the listener so that the angles between the lines from  
each surround back speaker to the listener and a line  
straight back from the listener are about 30 degrees,  
forming an equilateral triangle of the listener and the two  
surround back speakers.  
*When using a THX-certied speaker system, also refer to  
Speaker Placement Suitable for THX Audioon the next  
page.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
Subwoofer  
Using a subwoofer greatly improves the volume level and  
sound quality of bass sounds. The subwoofer effect depends  
not only on the listening position but also on the shape of the  
listening room.  
In general, place the subwoofer in a corner of the room or at  
a point 1/3 the width of the room.  
Corner  
Play a movie or music that contains high quality bass  
sounds to determine the subwoofer placement. Change the  
subwoofers position and check the effect, then select the  
position where the bass sounds are best heard.  
You can place two subwoofers for more powerful and  
richer heavy bass sounds.  
1/3 room  
length  
Speaker Placement Suitable for THX Audio  
To enjoy sources using the THX Cinema or THX Surround EX  
technology, we recommend using a THX speaker system from  
THX Ltd. A speaker system supporting the THX Ultra2  
standard is best suited for THX Ultra2 Cinema or THX Music  
Mode.  
The layout example on the right represents a case using the  
dipole speakers. A dipole speaker is a two-way directivity  
speaker that outputs the same sound in two directions such as  
forward and backward.  
Most dipole speakers are marked with an arrow indicating how  
they should be oriented in the room in order to match their  
phases*. Dipole surround speakers should be placed so that  
their arrows point forward toward the screen, and dipole  
surround back speakers should be placed so that their arrows  
point toward each other.  
Layout with dipole speakers  
1
TV or screen  
Subwoofer  
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
3
4
5
Front left speaker  
Center speaker  
Front right speaker  
Surround left speaker  
Surround right  
speaker  
Surround back left  
speaker  
Surround back right  
speaker  
6
7
8
9
10  
8
9
10 Listening position  
*Phase: The word represents the waveform position in one cycle (0 to 360 degrees) of a sine wave. If  
the phase does not match between multiple waveforms due to the distance between multiple speakers,  
the speaker orientation, or the miswiring of positive and negative poles, the sound image or space may  
be obscured or the sound may be less easy to listened to.  
When playing the source in the THX Ultra2 Cinema or THX Music Mode format using two  
surround back speakers supporting the THX Ultra2 standard, place them as close together as  
possible. After placing the surround back speakers, perform the settings described in the  
THX Audio Setup(page 91).  
6
7
10  
As close as  
possible  
8
9
Speaker Placement Suitable for a Music Source such as DVD-Audio  
This placement is based on the ITU-R* recommendation. In this placement, ve  
speakers with the same performance capabilities are used for front left and right,  
Center  
60  
Front  
Right  
Front  
Left  
center, and left and right surround speakers, and they are placed so that the distances  
between every speaker and the listening position are equal to each other and the  
heights of the speaker and the listeners ears are in the same. A mixing studio used  
for making multichannel DVD-Audio source material adopts this placement.  
Sub-  
woofer  
*ITU-R: International Telecommunication Union Radiocommunication Sector  
SL  
SR  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
5 ch/5.1 ch  
Available Speaker Placements  
This placement is suitable for  
playing 5.1 ch sources  
According to the Number of Speakers  
SW  
FR  
FL  
C
The following speaker placements will be available  
according to the number of speakers connected to the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. For the number of speaker  
channel, _.1 ch represents a subwoofer.  
including analog multichannel,  
Dolby Digital, DTS, and AAC  
format sources. When the  
source is 2 ch or mono, the  
signal will be decoded with  
Dolby Pro Logic II or DTS  
NEO:6 format and played as  
5.1 ch sources.  
Key to abbreviations:  
FL: Front left speaker, FR: Front right speaker, C: Center  
speaker, SL: Surround left speaker, SR: Surround right  
speaker, SBL: Surround back left speaker, SBR: Surround  
back right speaker, SW: Subwoofer  
When the number of channels in the source is 6.1 or  
greater, the surround back signal will be distributed  
through the surround left and right speakers  
accordingly.  
2 ch/2.1 ch  
This placement is used with  
two speakers (front left and  
right speakers). It is  
SW  
FR  
FL  
6 ch/6.1 ch/7 ch/7.1 ch (with center speaker)  
optimum for 2 ch sources  
including analog 2 ch, 2 ch  
linear PCM, Dolby Digital,  
DTS, DTS96/24, and AAC  
format sources. When the  
number of channels in the  
source is 3.1 or greater, the  
signals will be distributed  
This placement is suitable for  
playing 6.1 ch sources  
including DTS-ES Matrix/  
Discrete and Dolby Surround  
EX format signals.  
When you use two surround  
back speakers, the same signal  
will be output from them  
because the surround back  
channel is mono. When the  
source is 2 ch or mono, it will  
be decoded with the Dolby  
Pro Logic IIx/DTS NEO:6  
format and played as 6.1/7.1  
ch sources.  
SW  
FR  
FL  
C
through the left and right channels accordingly.  
SB  
C
3 ch/3.1 ch  
SW  
FR  
FL  
This placement is used with  
three speakers (front left,  
front right, and center  
speakers). When the number  
of channels in the source is  
4.1 or greater, the signal for  
surround and surround back  
channels will be output  
through the front left and  
right speakers.  
SW  
FR  
FL  
C
SBL  
SBR  
6 ch/6.1 ch/5 ch/5.1 ch (without center speaker)  
4 ch/4.1 ch  
This placement is suitable for  
SW  
playing 5.1 or 6.1 ch sources  
when the surround back  
sound is much more  
preferred than the center  
sound with less speaker units  
than the normal  
conguration. The center  
channel signal will be output  
through the front left and  
right speakers.  
FR  
FL  
In this placement, when the  
number of channels in the  
source is 5.1 or greater, the  
center channel signal will be  
output through the front left  
and right speakers, and the  
surround back channels will  
be output through the  
SW  
FR  
FL  
SBL  
SBR  
surround speakers.  
SW  
FR  
FL  
SB  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
Connection Examples  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E has two speaker terminal blocks for speaker system [A] and [B]. This allows you to  
build two 7.1 ch home theater systems, and various speaker placements and connections are also available. For  
example, some channels of either speaker system can be used for another room (Zone 2), or you can select one of two  
speaker systems for playback according to the source.  
When you use two speaker systems, you have to associate the speakers with the zone (e.g., Main A, Main B, etc.).  
After making the association, for example, pressing the MAIN Abutton on the remote controller will output the  
source from the speakers congured as Main A.”  
Here are some examples of speaker placement and zone association. These examples can be your reference when you  
build your own home theater system. The illustration on the right represents the actual settings displayed corresponding to  
each example. For details on conguring speaker placement and zone association, see page 88.  
*In the following illustrations, white speakers denote speaker system [A] and gray ones denote speaker system [B].  
*Key to abbreviations:  
FL: Front left speaker; FR: Front right speaker; C: Center speaker; SL: Surround left speaker; SR: Surround right speaker;  
SBL: Surround back left speaker; SBR: Surround back right speaker; SW: Subwoofer  
When you wish to congure 7.1 ch speaker system in the main room A only, the initial setting can be used without  
any modication.  
Main room A: 7.1 ch speaker system; Main room B: 7.1ch speaker system  
SW  
FR  
SW  
FR  
1-1.Speaker Config  
=====================  
FL  
C
FL  
C
Speaker A  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
b.Center  
:Main A  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
Main room A  
Main room B  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Main B  
g.Center  
:Main B  
h.Surr L/R :Main B  
i.Surr Back  
:Main B 2ch  
SBL  
SBR  
SBL  
SBR  
j.Subwoofer :Main B  
Set all the zone parameters for speaker system [A] to Main A.”  
Set all the zone parameters for speaker system [B] to Main B.”  
Pressing the [MAIN A] or [MAIN B] button causes the sound to be output  
from the speaker system associated with the zone button. Both speaker  
systems cannot be selected simultaneously.  
* If you set all the zone parameters for speaker system [B] to Main Aand play a single  
source, the same audio signal will be output from both speaker systems [A] and [B].  
Main room A: 7.1 ch speaker system; Main room B: 5.1 ch speaker system; Sub room (Zone 2): 2 ch  
speakers  
1-1.Speaker Config  
SW  
FR  
SW  
FR  
=====================  
FR  
FL  
FL  
C
FL  
C
Speaker A  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
Zone 2  
b.Center  
:Main A  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
Main room B  
Main room A  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Main B  
g.Center  
:Main B  
h.Surr L/R :Main B  
i.Surr Back  
Main B  
Powered  
Zone 2  
:Powered Zone 2  
j.Subwoofer :Main B  
SBL  
SBR  
Set all the zone parameters for speaker system [A] to Main A.Set the zone parameters for  
speaker system [B] to Main Band Zone 2accordingly.  
Both main room A and B cannot be used simultaneously. However, while either of the main  
rooms is used, you can enjoy a different source in Zone 2.  
Note that when you use Zone 2, the surround back speakers for main room A cannot be used  
since Zone 2 uses the surround back speaker circuit for main room A.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
Main room A: 7.1 ch speaker systems and the two additional front speakers  
(When you want to use speaker system [A] for movies and enjoy 7.1 surround sound and the two additional front  
speakers for classic music.)  
1-1.Speaker Config  
3-3.Stereo  
=====================  
FR FR  
FL FL  
C
=====================  
Speaker A  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
:Off  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
b.Center  
:Main A  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
b.Front Speaker: B  
c.Subwoofer: A  
Main room A  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Main A  
g.Center  
:Not Used  
h.Surr L/R :Not Used  
i.Surr Back  
SBL  
SBR  
:Not Used  
j.Subwoofer :Not Used  
Here is an example of the  
stereo sources.  
Set all the zone parameters for speaker system [A] to Main A.”  
Set the front speaker parameters for speaker system [B] to Main A.”  
If you want to use the front speakers of speaker system [B] for specic sources, select the source and set the front  
speaker setting parameters to Bin the listening mode setup menu.  
When you want to output to both speaker systems simultaneously, you can choose the A+Bsetting unless any of  
the speakers has an impedance of 8 ohm or lower.  
To output the sound, press the [MAIN A] button on the remote controller.  
Main room A: 7.1 ch speaker system and the two additional front speakers connected through the  
BTL or bi-amp connection (when you want to use either the 7.1 ch speakers or the additional front  
speakers according to the source)  
1-1.Speaker Config  
3-3.Stereo  
=====================  
FR  
FL  
C
FR  
=====================  
FL  
Speaker A  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
:Off  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
b.Center  
:Main A  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
b.Front Speaker: B  
c.Subwoofer: A  
Main room A  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Main A  
g.Center  
:Not Used  
h.Surr L/R :Not Used  
i.Surr Back  
SBL  
SBR  
:BTL for Front  
j.Subwoofer :Not Used  
Here is an example of the  
stereo sources.  
Set all the zone parameters for speaker system [A] to Main A.”  
For speaker system [B], set the front speaker parameters to Main Aand the surround back speaker parameters to  
BTL for Front or Bi-Amp for Front(For details on connections, see page 27).  
When you want to use the front speakers of speaker system [B] for specic sources, select the source and set the  
front speaker parameters to Bin the listening mode setup menu.  
*When using the BTL or bi-amp connections, the two speaker systems cannot be used to output simultaneously due to the speaker  
impedance limitation.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker Placement—Continued  
Main room A: 5.1 ch speaker system including the front speakers connected through the BTL or bi-  
amp connections  
C
1-1.Speaker Config  
FR  
FL  
=====================  
Speaker A  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
b.Center  
:Main A  
Main room A  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
:BTL for Front  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Not Used  
g.Center  
:Not Used  
h.Surr L/R :Not Used  
i.Surr Back  
:Not Used  
j.Subwoofer :Not Used  
For speaker system [A], set the surround back speaker parameters to BTL for Front or Bi-Amp for Frontand all  
the other speaker parameters to Main A(For details on speaker connections, see page 27).  
For speaker system [B], set the speaker parameters to Not Used.”  
*When using the BTL or bi-amp connections, you cannot use Zone 2 since the surround back channel is used for the front speakers of  
main room A.  
Main room A: 7.1 ch from the speaker system [A] and additional subwoofer and surround speakers  
from speaker system [B] (suitable for enjoying more powerful and lively surround sound in main  
room A); Main room B: two front speakers from speaker system [B] using the BTL or bi-amp  
connections  
FL  
FR  
1-1.Speaker Config  
FR  
FL  
C
3-5.Multichannel Input  
=====================  
=====================  
Speaker A  
Main room B  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
b.Center  
:Main A  
Main room A  
b.Re-EQ  
:Off  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Surr L/R Sp  
g.Subwoofer  
:A+B  
:A+B  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Speaker B  
f.Front L/R :Main B  
g.Center  
:Not Used  
h.Surr L/R :Main A  
i.Surr Back  
SBL  
SBR  
:BTL for Front  
j.Subwoofer :Main A  
Here is an example of the  
multichannel sources.  
For speaker system [A], set all the speaker parameters to Main A.”  
For speaker system [B], set the surround speaker and subwoofer parameters to Main A,the front speaker  
parameters to Main B,and the surround back speaker parameters to BTL for Frontor Bi-Amp for Front(For  
details on speaker connection, see page 27).  
When you want to use the surround speakers and subwoofer of speaker system [B] for specic sources, select the  
source and set the parameters for these speakers to Bor A+Bin the listening mode setup menu.  
When you set the parameter to B,the audio signal comes out from the surround speakers and subwoofer of  
speaker system [B]. When you set the parameter to A+B,the signal comes out from the surround speakers and  
subwoofer of both speaker systems [A] and [B].  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Speakers  
Attaching the Speaker Labels  
Connecting to the Speaker Terminals  
The positive speaker terminals on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E are color coded for easy identication.  
Attach the supplied speaker labels to the speaker cables,  
and then match the colors on the speaker cables to the  
corresponding terminals.  
After determining the layout of your speaker system, it  
is now necessary to connect the speakers correctly to  
your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
For the USA and Canadian models, you can also use  
banana plugs/connectors.  
Speaker label  
Speaker label  
Caution:  
Connect only speakers with an impedance between 4 and  
16 to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. If the impedance  
of even one speaker is between 4 and 6 , be sure to set the  
speaker impedance setting accordingly (See page 89).  
The speaker channels are colored as follows:  
Front left speaker (+): White  
Front right speaker (+): Red  
Notes:  
Even if you are using only one speaker or listening to  
monaural (mono) sound, never connect a single speaker  
in parallel to both the right and left channel terminals.  
Center speaker (+): Green  
Surround left speaker (+): Blue  
Surround right speaker (+): Grey  
Surround back/Zone 2 left speaker (+): Brown  
Surround back/Zone 2 right speaker (+): Tan  
Front right  
speaker  
Center  
speaker  
Front left  
speaker  
R
L
Topreventcircuitrydamage, never  
short-circuit the positive (+) and  
negative () speaker wire.  
Be sure to connect the positive and  
negative cables for the speakers  
properly. If they are mixed up, the  
left and right signals will be  
reversed and the audio will sound unnatural.  
Do not connect more than one speaker cable to one  
speaker terminal. Doing so may damage the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SPEAKERS  
A
Connecting the Speaker Cable  
1. Strip away approx. 5/8 inch (15 mm) of the wire  
insulation.  
2. Twist the wire ends tightly together.  
3. Unscrew the speaker terminal cap.  
4. Insert the exposed wire end.  
5. Tighten speaker terminal cap.  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR BACK  
L
SURR  
L
(
)
SINGLE  
SPEAKERS  
A
SPEAKERS  
A
1
2
5/8"  
(15 mm)  
3
4
5
Tip:  
Surround  
right  
speaker  
Surround  
left  
speaker  
The terminal wrench that  
comes with this unit is a  
useful tool for tightening/  
loosening the speaker  
terminal cap.  
Surround  
back right  
speaker  
Surround  
back left  
speaker  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Speakers—Continued  
Connecting a Subwoofer  
Connecting Auxiliary Power Amplier  
(For Speaker System [A] only)  
Use the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A/B jack to connect  
a subwoofer with a built-in power amplier. If your  
subwoofer does not have a built-in amplier, connect an  
amplier to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A/B jack and  
the subwoofer to the amplier.  
These jacks are for connecting an auxiliary power  
amplier. The PRE OUT terminals on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E use the mode settings for speaker system  
[A].  
You can connect two subwoofers for different speaker  
systems. You have to assign a subwoofer to the room in  
which it will be used (See pages 88, 89).  
You can use an auxiliary power amplier to listen at  
louder volumes than you can with the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E alone. When using a power amplier,  
connect each speaker to the power amplier.  
MULTI  
-
F
AUDIO IN  
L
G
C
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
D
1
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
E
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
C
H
I
N
1
R
R
L
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
1
PH  
4
5
6
7
8
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
GND  
SL  
R
L
Net-Tune”  
trademark of  
1
2
3
is  
a
Onkyo Corporation.  
SBR  
SBL  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
(Net-Tune)  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
SL  
1
SBR  
SBL  
LINE INPUT  
3
5
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
OU  
MULTI  
G
S
VIDEO  
H
-
C
H
I
N
2
A
B
C
D
F
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
to White  
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
B
L
PRE OUT A  
SURR  
L
to Brown  
L
R
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
C
E
N
T
E
R
S
U
B
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT L  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
OUT  
B
L
LINE INPUT  
R
R
to Red  
R
to Tan  
SUB  
SUB  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
PRE  
OUT A  
OUT B  
CENTER  
to Blue  
L
to Gray  
R
to Green  
Center  
Front  
Surround  
Surround back  
R
L
R
L
R
L
INPUT  
INPUT  
INPUT  
INPUT  
R
L
R
L
R
L
Power amplier  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1. Front left speaker  
2. Front right speaker  
3. Center speaker  
4. Surround left  
speaker  
6. Surround back left  
speaker  
7. Surround back right  
speaker  
5. Surround right  
speaker  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Speakers—Continued  
Caution:  
Using the BTL Connection  
• When making the bi-amp connection, make sure  
to remove the shorting bars connecting the high  
range (Tweeter) and low range (Woofer)  
terminals.  
When using the bi-amp connection, make sure that  
the speaker impedance is 8 ohm or higher.  
For the settings on the bi-amp connection, see pages 88,  
89.  
To get more powerful sound output, you can make the  
BTL (Bridged Transless) connection using the front and  
surround back speaker terminals on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. In this connection, two speaker outputs  
of the stereo amplier will be used as mono output by  
combining the individual stereo channel outputs,  
allowing you to get about twice the output.  
Bi-wiring-enabled speakers  
Note:  
When using the BTL connection, make sure that the  
speaker impedance is 8 ohm or higher.  
For the settings on the BTL connection, see pages 88,  
89.  
Right speaker  
Left speaker  
High  
range  
(Tweeter)  
Low  
range  
(Woofer)  
Right speaker  
Left speaker  
( )  
SURR BACK L ASSIGNABLE  
SINGLE  
FRONT L  
(
SURR BACK R ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT R  
(
)
( )  
SURR BACK L ASSIGNABLE  
SINGLE  
FRONT L  
(
SURR BACK R ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT R  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
(
)
PR  
2
2
3
5
2
4
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
MULTI  
G
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
-
C
H
IN  
OUT  
I
N
2
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
SINGLE  
L
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
(
)
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
SPEAKERS  
A
B
L
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
R
B
SPEAKERS  
C
E
N
T
E
R
S
U
B
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
L
(BTL)  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
UDC/UDT  
MODEL NO. TX-NR1000  
OUT  
B
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
P
R
2
2
3
5
2
4
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
MULTI  
G
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
1. Connect the (+) tweeter terminal of the right  
-
C
H
IN  
OUT  
I
N
2
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
SINGLE  
L
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
(
)
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
SPEAKERS  
A
B
L
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
speaker to the FRONT R SPEAKERS (+) terminal  
on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the (+)  
woofer terminal of the right speaker to the SURR  
BACK R SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
R
B
SPEAKERS  
C
E
N
T
E
R
S
U
B
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
L
(BTL)  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
UDC/UDT  
MODEL NO. TX-NR1000  
OUT  
B
In the BTL connection, the () L/R speaker terminals on  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will not be used.  
1. Connect the (+) terminal on the right speaker to the  
FRONT R SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the () terminal on  
the right speaker to the SURR BACK R  
2. Connect the () tweeter terminal of the right  
speaker to the FRONT R SPEAKERS () terminal  
on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the ()  
woofer terminal of the right speaker to the SURR  
BACK R SPEAKERS () terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
3. Connect the (+) tweeter terminal of the left speaker  
to the FRONT L SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the (+) woofer  
terminal of the left speaker to the SURR BACK L  
SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
2. Connect the (+) terminal on the left speaker to the  
FRONT L SPEAKERS (+) terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the () terminal on  
the left speaker to the SURR BACK L SPEAKERS  
(+) terminal on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
4. Connect the () tweeter terminal of the left speaker  
to the FRONT L SPEAKERS () terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the () woofer  
terminal of the left speaker to the SURR BACK L  
SPEAKERS () terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Using Bi-amp Connection  
When you use bi-wiring-enabled speakers for the front  
speakers, you can make the bi-amp connection. In this  
connection, the front and surround back speaker  
terminals will be used for tweeter and woofer,  
respectively. This connection allows you to obtain high  
quality sound as well as maximum treble and bass  
performance from the tweeter and woofer, enriching  
your sound experience.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Antennas  
This chapter explains how to connect the supplied indoor  
FM antenna and AM loop antenna, and how to connect  
commercially available outdoor FM and AM antennas.  
FM antenna connector  
Connecting the AM Loop Antenna  
The supplied indoor AM loop antenna is for indoor use  
only.  
AM antenna push terminals  
COMPONENT  
MULTI  
F
G
J
K
L
C
DIGITAL IN  
D
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
E
AUDIO IN  
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
I
Assemble the AM loop antenna, inserting  
the tabs into the base, as shown.  
-
VIDEO  
IN 2  
R
L
R
L
OPTICAL  
ICNH1  
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
ANTENNA  
HDMI  
4
1
4
5
6
7
8
1
1
1
PH  
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
P
B
R
GND  
P
B
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
P
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
SBR  
SBL  
OUT  
1
IN 3  
A
P
R
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
Y
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
P
P
B
R
100mA MAX.  
(
-
)
Y
Net Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
P
B
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
P
R
3
5
2
R
R
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
G
-
ICNH2  
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
SINGLE  
L
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
(
)
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
SPEAKERS  
SPEAKERS  
A
B
L
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
R
B
CENTER SUB  
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
L
(BTL)  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
UDC/UDT  
-
MODEL NO. TX NR1000  
OUT  
B
Connect both wires of the AM loop  
antenna to the AM push terminals, as  
shown.  
2
Connecting the Indoor FM Antenna  
The supplied indoor FM antenna is for indoor use only.  
(The antennas wires are not polarity sensitive, so  
they can be connected in either terminal)  
Make sure that the wires are attached securely  
and that the push terminals are gripping the bare  
wires, not the insulation.  
Attach the FM antenna, as shown.  
1
I USA and Canadian Model  
FM  
75  
Insert the plug fully  
into the socket.  
I Other Models  
Push  
Insert wire  
Release  
AM  
FM  
75  
Insert the plug fully  
into the socket  
Once your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is ready  
for use, youll need to tune into an AM radio  
station and adjust the position of the AM antenna  
to achieve the best possible reception. Keep the  
antenna as far away as possible from your  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, TV, speaker cables,  
and power cords.  
Once your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is ready  
for use, youll need to tune into an FM radio  
station and adjust the position of the FM antenna  
to achieve the best possible reception.  
Use thumbtacks or something similar to  
x the FM antenna into position.  
2
If you cannot achieve good reception with the supplied  
indoor AM loop antenna, try using a commercially  
available outdoor AM antenna.  
Thumbtacks, etc.  
Caution: Be careful that you dont injure  
yourself when using thumbtacks.  
If you cannot achieve good reception with the supplied  
indoor FM antenna, try using a commercially available  
outdoor FM antenna instead.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Antennas—Continued  
Connecting an Outdoor FM Antenna  
If you cannot achieve good reception with the supplied  
indoor FM antenna, try using a commercially available  
outdoor FM antenna instead.  
FM  
75  
Notes:  
Outdoor FM antennas work best outside, but acceptable  
results can sometimes be obtained when installed in an attic  
or loft.  
For best results, install the outdoor FM antenna well away  
from tall buildings, preferably with a clear line of sight to  
your local FM transmitter.  
Outdoor antennas should be located away from possible  
noise sources, such as neon signs, busy roads, etc.  
For safety reasons, outdoor antennas should be situated well  
away from power lines and other high voltage equipment.  
Outdoor antennas must be grounded in accordance with local  
regulations to prevent electric shock hazards.  
Using a TV/FM Antenna Splitter  
Its best not to use the same antenna for both FM and TV  
reception, as this can cause interference problems. If  
circumstances demand it, use a TV/FM antenna splitter, as  
shown.  
TV/FM antenna splitter  
To AV receiver  
To TV (or VCR)  
Connecting an Outdoor AM Antenna  
If good reception cannot be achieved using the supplied  
AM loop antenna, an outdoor AM antenna can be used  
in addition to the loop antenna, as shown.  
Outdoor antenna (aerial)  
Insulated antenna cable  
AM loop antenna  
AM  
Outdoor AM antennas work best when installed outside  
horizontally, but good results can sometimes be obtained  
indoors by mounting it horizontally above a window.  
Note that the AM loop antenna should be left connected.  
Outdoor antennas must be grounded in accordance with  
local regulations to prevent electric shock hazards.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components  
Types of Connection Cables and Terminals  
In addition to the conventional terminals, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E has various terminals that are capable of next-  
generation digital transmission.  
Before connecting AV components to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make sure that your cable type matches the ter-  
minal shape and the signal type and that the cable length is appropriate for the placement of your connected components.  
Audio cables  
Cable names  
Cable forms  
Terminals shapes  
Description  
Optical cable  
The connection using these cable types trans-  
mits digital audio signals. There is no sound  
quality difference among these cable types.  
Note:  
Some optical cables have their own covers.  
Before making a connection, remove the cov-  
ers. When plugging in a cable, be sure to match  
the connector shape with the terminal shape.  
Each optical terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E has its own shutter-type cover.  
For the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, plug in the  
optical cables so that the optical cable connec-  
tor pushes the terminal cover down.  
Coaxial cable  
Audio connection  
cable  
This connection transmits an analog audio sig-  
nal. Plug the red connector (R) into the right  
channel terminal and the white connector (L)  
into the left channel connector.  
Multichannel con-  
nection cable  
MULTI  
-
INCH1  
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
C
The terminals for this cable type are for DVD  
players that are compatible with the DVD-Audio  
format. This connection transmits multichannel  
analog audio signals.  
SL  
SBR  
SBL  
i.LINK (AUDIO) con-  
nection cable  
(4-pin (S400) type)  
This connection can be used for connecting  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-enabled devices and to transmit  
digital audio signals. Also, multichannel analog  
audio signals from DVD-Audio or Super Audio  
CD format sources will be transmitted digitally.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E handles only  
audio signals through i.LINK connection.  
Ethernet cable  
(CAT-5 Straight  
type)  
The Ethernet cable is used for connecting multi-  
ple PCs or network-ready audio components  
that constitute a local area network (LAN). A  
LAN is a smaller network composed within a  
house or building. The connecting terminals for  
the Ethernet cables are often called “LAN port”  
or “broadband port.”  
ETHERNET  
(
)
-
Net Tune  
*The audio input signal from the ETHERNET (Net-Tune) or MULTI-CH IN terminal will not be output to the HDMI  
OUT terminal. Also, the DVD audio or SACD audio input signal from the i.LINK (AUDIO) terminal will not be output  
to the HDMI OUT terminal.  
When you play a source in the remote zone (Zone 2 or Zone 3), the following restrictions are applied.  
When you play the audio signal from Super Audio CD or DVD-Audio format sources through the i.LINK (AUDIO)  
interface, the audio input signal from these sources will not be output to Zone 2 or Zone 3. With this connection, you  
cannot record from these sources.  
When you play the audio signal from the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface in Zone 3, only the PCM signal will be output  
as an analog source to the AUDIO OUT terminals. Similarly, with this connection, you can record only the PCM sig-  
nal as an analog source through the AUDIO OUT terminals.  
The audio input signal from the LAN port will be output only to the AUDIO OUT terminals as an analog source.  
When you play the audio signal from the PH or AUDIO IN terminals in Zone 3, the input source will be output only  
to the AUDIO OUT terminals as an analog source. Similarly, in this connection, you can record only the audio signal  
as an analog source through the AUDIO OUT terminals.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
When you play the audio signal from the DIGITAL IN terminals in Zone 2, the source will be downmixed into 2-  
channel analog audio signal and output to the AUDIO OUT terminals.  
When you play the audio signal from the DIGITAL IN terminals in Zone 3, only the PCM signal will be output as an  
analog source to the AUDIO OUT terminals. Similarly, with this connection, you can record only the PCM signal as  
an analog source through the AUDIO OUT terminals.  
The audio input signal from the HDMI IN terminal can be output to the HDMI OUT terminal.  
The audio input signal from the MULTI-CH IN terminals in Zone 2 will be downmixed into a 2-channel source for  
output. You cannot play the source from the MULTI-CH IN terminals in Zone 3 and record it.  
Video cables  
Cable names  
Cable forms  
Terminals shapes  
Description  
Component video  
connection cable  
(RCA type)  
Y
Y
PB  
PR  
PB  
PR  
In this connection, the video signal is decom-  
posed into three color difference signals (Y, Pb/  
Cb, and Pr/Cr) and carried through three  
cables, which provides better video quality than  
the S Video connection.  
The terminal shape for the component video  
connection cable can be BNC-type or RCA-  
type. For the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, the US  
model is equipped only with RCA-type termi-  
nals, and the other models are equipped with  
both RCA-type and BNC-type terminals.  
This connection cannot transmit information for  
controlling video devices (e.g., aspect ratio).  
Component video  
connection cable  
(BNC type)  
Y
Y
P
P
B
P
P
B
R
R
S Video connection  
cable  
The video quality is better than with the com-  
posite signal. In this connection, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E cannot transmit the  
information for controlling video devices (e.g.,  
aspect ratio).  
Video connection  
cable  
This connection transmits the standard video  
signal and is widely used for various video  
devices such as TV and video recorder.  
HDMI connection  
cable  
This connection carries the video signals digi-  
tally.  
(Note that no audio signal is carried with this  
unit.)  
Note:  
When you play the source in the remote zone (Zone 2 or Zone 3), connect the TV or monitor to the VIDEO 1, VIDEO  
2, or VIDEO 3 terminal.  
• Always refer to the instructions that came with the component that you are connecting.  
• Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been properly made.  
• Insert all plugs and connectors securely. Improper connections can result in noise, poor performance, or  
damage to the equipment.  
Example: Audio connection cable  
Wrong!  
Right!  
• Do not bind audio/video connection cables with power cords and speaker cables. Doing so may adversely  
affect the picture and sound quality.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting Monitors such as TV or Projector  
This section describes the connections for displaying the video source or the operating information of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E on a monitor device such as a TV or projector. Before making a connection, check the  
terminal types on the monitor device and acquire the necessary cables by referring to page 31.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E incorporates a video converter, which allows you to enjoy the video source even  
when the connections between the playback device and the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and between the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and the monitors are different. When your TV or monitor has various types of input ter-  
minals, use the connection with which you can get the best video quality (For a model with no HDMI terminal, note  
that the input signal from the COMPONENT terminal will be output only to the COMPONENT terminal).  
The VIDEO OUT 4 and S VIDEO OUT 4 terminals can be used only for Main room A.  
When you enjoy the video source in the remote zone (Zone 2 or Zone 3), the TV or monitor should be connected to  
the VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, or VIDEO 3 terminal.  
*For more information on the HDMI interface, see page 43.  
Make a connection using any of the terminals below.  
*1 When connecting to the other S VIDEO OUT terminal, congure the video output  
settings accordingly using the Video Output Assign sub-menu (See page 92).  
*2 When connecting to the other VIDEO OUT terminal, congure the video output  
settings accordingly using the Video Output Assign sub-menu (See page 92).  
*3 European and Asian models only.  
Monitor device  
such asTV and  
projector for  
Main room A  
VIDEO  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO (RCA)  
IN  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO (BNC)  
IN  
HDMI  
IN  
S VIDEO  
IN  
*3  
Y
Y
PR  
PR  
PB  
PB  
*2  
*1  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
K
J
L
H
I
S VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
L
IN  
1
IN  
2
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
PB  
PR  
REMOTE  
12V  
CONTROL  
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
OUT  
1
IN  
3
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
PB  
MAIN  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
PR  
2
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
L
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
OUT  
I
J
K
*2  
*2  
*2  
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
Monitor device such asTV  
for Main room B  
Monitor device such as TV  
for Zone 2  
Monitor device such as TV  
for Zone 3  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a DVD Player  
When connecting a DVD player to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections for video and audio signals  
using digital and analog terminals. Before making connections, refer to page 30 for correct connections.  
When you want to perform analog recording of the audio signal from a DVD player or operate your  
-compatible  
Onkyo products via connections between the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, you have to make analog audio signal  
connections. Connect the audio output terminals on the DVD player to the AUDIO IN terminals on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E using analog audio cables (RCA/phono).  
This section shows the connection example when you use the default settings of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
However, you can connect a DVD player to other terminals within the same terminal section on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. In such case, remember to congure the audio input assignment in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See  
page 94) and the video input assignment in the Video Assign sub-menu (See page 95).  
For a model without a HDMI terminal, when you connect a DVD player to the COMPONENT terminals, be sure to  
use the COMPONENT terminal to connect a TV or projector.  
*For more information on the HDMI interface, see page 43.  
*For more information on the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface, see page 40.  
DVD player  
When connecting to other audio terminals  
within the same terminal section, congure  
the audio input settings accordingly using the  
Audio Assign sub-menu. (See page 94.)  
When connecting to other video terminals  
within the same terminal section, congure  
the video input settings accordingly using the  
Video Assign sub-menu. (See page 95.)  
VIDEO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
MULTICH OUT  
CENTER  
SURR  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
AUDIO OUT  
DIGITAL  
S VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
COMPONENT  
OUT (RCA)  
HDMI  
OUT  
SURR BACK  
FRONT  
L
L
Y
PB  
PR  
R
R
OPTICAL  
SUB  
WOOFER  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
-INCH1  
IN  
1
R
L
R
L
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
G
-INCH2  
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
L
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
A
(
)
SINGLE  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a DVD Recorder or Digital VCR (VIDEO 1)  
When connecting a DVD recorder or digital VCR to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections for video  
and audio signals using digital and analog terminals. Before making connections, refer to page 30 for correct con-  
nections.  
This section shows the connection example when you use the VIDEO 1 as an input. In this case, you do not need  
additional congurations. When connecting to other terminals within the same terminal section on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, congure the audio input assignment in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See page 94), the video input  
assignment in the Video Assign sub-menu (See page 95), the audio output assignment in the Audio Output Assign  
sub-menu (See page 91), and the video output assignment in the Video Output Assign sub-menu (See page 92).  
You can change the display name for the input source to represent the actual connected device (See page 97).  
When you want to perform analog recording of the audio signal from the digital device, you have to make analog  
audio signal connections. Connect the audio output terminals on the digital device to the AUDIO IN terminals on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E using analog audio cables (RCA/phono).  
For a model without a HDMI terminal, when you connect a DVD recorder or digital VCR to the COMPONENT ter-  
minals, be sure to use the COMPONENT terminals to connect a TV or projector.  
*For more information on the HDMI interface, see page 43.  
*For more information on the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface, see page 40.  
Example for connecting with the VIDEO 1 as input  
Digital video recorder  
(DVD recorder, digital VCR)  
When connecting to other  
When connecting to other video  
VIDEO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
audio terminals within same  
terminal section, congure  
the audio input settings  
accordingly using the Audio  
Assign sub-menu (See page  
94).  
terminals within the same termi-  
nal section, congure the video  
input settings accordingly using  
theVideoAssign sub-menu (See  
page 95).  
AUDIO OUT  
DIGITAL  
COAXIAL  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
S VIDEO VIDEO  
OUT  
OUT  
COMPONENT  
OUT (RCA)  
Y
PB  
PR  
R
L
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
L
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
-INCH2  
G
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
When connecting to other  
video terminals within the  
same terminal section, con-  
gure the video output set-  
tings accordingly using the  
Video Output Assign sub-  
menu (See page 92).  
When connecting to other  
audio terminals within the  
same terminal section, con-  
gure the audio output set-  
tings accordingly using the  
Audio Output Assign sub-  
menu (See page 91).  
R
L
AUDIO IN  
DIGITAL  
COAXIAL  
S VIDEO VIDEO  
IN  
IN  
AUDIO IN  
ANALOG  
VIDEO IN  
AUDIO IN  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a VCR (VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3)  
When connecting a VCR to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections for video and audio signals. Before  
making connections, refer to page 30 for correct connections.  
This section shows the connection example when you use VIDEO 2 or VIDEO 3 as an input. In this case, you do not  
need additional congurations. When connecting to other terminals within the same terminal section on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, congure the audio input assignment in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See page 94), the  
video input assignment in the Video Assign sub-menu (See page 95), the audio output assignment in the Audio Out-  
put Assign menu (See page 91), and the video output assignment in the Video Output Assign menu (See page 92).  
You can change the display name for the input source to represent the actual connected device (See page 97).  
For a model without a HDMI terminal, when you connect a VCR to the COMPONENT terminals, be sure to use the  
COMPONENT terminals to connect a TV or projector.  
*For more information on the HDMI interface, see page 43.  
*For more information on the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface, see page 40.  
Example for connecting with the VIDEO 2 as input  
VCR  
When connecting to other  
audio terminals within the  
same terminal section, cong-  
ure the audio input settings  
accordingly using the Audio  
Assign sub-menu (See page  
94).  
When connecting to other  
video terminals within the  
same terminal section, cong-  
ure the video input settings  
accordingly using the Video  
Assign sub-menu (See page  
95).  
VIDEO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
DIGITAL  
COAXIAL  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
S VIDEO VIDEO  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO (RCA)  
OUT  
OUT  
Y
PB  
PR  
R
L
For digital  
VCR  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
L
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
HDMI  
IN  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
or registered  
75  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
-INCH2  
G
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
When connecting to other audio termi-  
nals within the same terminal section,  
congure the audio output settings  
accordingly using the Audio Output  
Assign sub-menu (See page 91).  
When connecting to other video ter-  
minals within the same terminal  
section, congure the video output  
settings accordingly using theVideo  
Output Assign sub-menu (See page  
92).  
R
L
S VIDEO  
IN  
AUDIO IN  
ANALOG  
AUDIO IN  
VIDEO IN  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Example for connecting with the VIDEO 3 as input  
VCR  
When connecting to other  
audio terminals within the  
When connecting to other  
video terminals within the  
same terminal section, con-  
gure the video input set-  
tings accordingly using the  
Video Assign sub-menu  
(See page 95).  
VIDEO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
same terminal section, cong-  
ure the audio input settings  
accordingly using the Audio  
Assign sub-menu (See page  
94).  
S VIDEO VIDEO  
OUT  
OUT  
COMPONENT  
OUT (RCA)  
Y
PB  
PR  
R
L
For digital  
*
VCR  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
-INCH1  
IN  
1
R
L
R
L
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
HDMI  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
or registered  
75  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
-INCH2  
G
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
When connecting to other audio termi-  
nals within the same terminal section,  
congure the audio output settings  
accordingly using the Audio Output  
Assign sub-menu (See page 91).  
When connecting to other video ter-  
minals within the same terminal  
section, congure the video output  
settings accordingly using theVideo  
Output Assign sub-menu (See page  
92).  
R
L
AUDIO IN  
ANALOG  
S VIDEO  
IN  
AUDIO IN  
VIDEO IN  
*European and Asian models use the BNC type component terminals, and other models use the RCA type.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a DBS Tuner, DBS TV, or BS/CS Tuner  
When connecting a DBS tuner, DBS TV, or BS/CS tuner to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections for  
video and audio signals using digital and analog terminals. Before making connections, refer to page 30 for correct  
connections.  
This section shows the connection example when you use the VIDEO 4 or VIDEO 5 as an input. In this case, you do  
not need additional congurations. When connecting to other terminals within the same terminal section on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, remember to congure the audio input assignment in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See  
page 94) and the video input assignment in the Video Assign sub-menu (See page 95). When you use the S VIDEO  
terminal for connection, you should congure the Video Assign sub-menu.  
You can change the display name for the input source to represent the actual connected device (See page 97).  
For a model without a slot for the HDMI terminal, when you connect a BS/CS tuner or LD player to the COMPO-  
NENT terminals, be sure to use the COMPONENT terminals to connect a TV or projector.  
*For more information on the HDMI interface, see page 43.  
*For more information on the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface, see page 40.  
Example for connecting with the VIDEO 4 as input  
When connecting to other video ter-  
minals within the same terminal sec-  
tion, congure the video input  
When connecting to other audio ter-  
minals within the same terminal sec-  
tion, congure the audio input  
AUDIO OUT  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
VIDEO  
OUT  
R
L
settings accordingly using the Video  
Assign sub-menu (See page 95).  
settings accordingly using the Audio  
Assign sub-menu (See page 94).  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
L
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
-INCH2  
G
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
R
L
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
DIGITAL  
COAXIAL  
When connecting to other  
audio terminals within the  
When connecting to other  
video terminals within the  
same terminal section, con- same terminal section, con-  
gure the audio input set-  
gure the video input set-  
tings accordingly using the  
tings accordingly using the  
AudioAssign sub-menu (See Video Assign sub-menu  
page 94). (See page 95).  
Example for connecting with the VIDEO 5 as input  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a Portable DVD Player or Video Camcorder  
• When connecting a portable DVD player or video  
camcorder to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, use the  
VIDEO 7 INPUT terminals on the front panel.  
You can change the display name for the input source  
to represent the actual connected device (See page  
97).  
Game, Portable DVD,  
Video Camcorder  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
VIDEO  
OUT  
S VIDEO  
OUT  
R
L
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
7
INPUT  
VIDEO  
OPTICAL  
S
L----AUDIO----R  
Connecting a CD Player,Turntable or Tuner  
• When connecting a CD player to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections using digital or analog termi-  
nals. Before making connections, refer to page 30 for correct connections. This section shows the connection exam-  
ple when you use the default audio input assignment settings. However, when you use coaxial cables for digital  
audio signals, connect the CD player to any terminal between the AUDIO IN DIGITAL COAXIAL 1 and 6, and  
remember to configure the audio input assignment settings in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See page 94).  
• When connecting a turntable, use the PH terminal. The PH terminal on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is designed  
for turntables that use a moving magnet (MM) cartridge. When you want to use a turntable with a moving coil (MC)  
cartridge, connect the turntable through a step-up transformer or head amplifier.  
• If you assign other terminals to the PHONO input source, you need to configure the audio input assignment settings  
in the Audio Assign sub-menu (See page 94).  
• When a turntable is equipped with a ground wire, connect the wire to the GND terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. However, some turntables may produce noise when the ground wire is connected to the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. In such a case, you do not have to connect the ground wire.  
• When you want to perform analog recording of the audio signal or operate your  
-compatible Onkyo products via  
connections between the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, you have to make analog audio signal connections. Con-  
nect the audio output terminals on the source device to the AUDIO IN terminals on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
using analog audio cables (RCA/phono).  
Turntable  
CD Player  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
When connecting to other audio terminals within the  
same terminal section, configure the audio input set-  
tings accordingly using the Audio Assign sub-menu  
(See page 94).  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
R
L
GND  
COMPONENT  
J
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
C
D
1
E
AUDIO IN  
L
H
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
I
L
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
VIDEO  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
IN 2  
FL  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
4
4
5
6
7
PH  
1
1
Y
PB  
PR  
Y
Y
C
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
HD  
“Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
1
2
is  
a
FM  
75  
or  
tra  
Lic  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connecting a Recording Device such as MD Recorder, DAT Deck, CD Recorder  
or Cassette Deck  
When connecting a MD recorder, DAT deck or CD recorder to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, make connections  
using digital or analog terminals. Before making connections, refer to page 30 for correct connections.  
Connect a cassette or DAT tape deck to TAPE1, and an MD or CD recorder to TAPE 2.  
When you connect a cassette deck to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, be sure to use only analog audio terminals. In  
the initial settings, no terminal of this unit is assigned to a REC terminal of the cassette deck. To achieve the assign-  
ment, connect the REC terminal of the cassette deck to any of the AUDIO OUT 1 to 5 terminals and set the terminal  
to Tape 1 Rec Outin the Audio Output Assign sub-menu (See page 91). In addition, you can switch the input source  
TAPE2to MD or CDR. Press the [TAPE 2] button on the front panel to display TAPE 2,then press the [TAPE 2]  
button again and hold it for 3 seconds. This changes the display to MD.If you wish to change it to CDR,release  
the button once, and press and hold it again for 3 seconds. This operation enables you to operate Onkyos MD or CD  
recorders with the remote controller of this unit (Please note that the  
connection is required).  
When connecting to other terminals, remember to congure the audio input assignment in the Audio Assign sub-  
menu (See page 94) and the audio output assignment in the Audio Output Assign sub-menu (See page 91).  
You can change the display name for the input source to represent the actual connected device (See page 97).  
When you want to perform analog recording of an audio signal or operate your  
-compatible Onkyo products via  
connections between the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, you have to make analog audio signal connections. Con-  
nect the audio output terminals on the source device to the AUDIO IN terminals on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
using analog audio cables (RCA/phono).  
Example for connecting with the TAPE 1 as input  
Cassette deck or DAT deck  
When connecting to other digital audio ter-  
minals or to other analog audio output ter-  
minals, congure the audio output settings  
accordingly using the Audio Output Assign  
sub-menu (See page 91).  
When connecting to other audio  
terminals within the same terminal  
section, congure the audio input  
settings accordingly using the  
Audio Assign sub-menu (See page  
94).  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
R
L
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
AUDIO IN  
H
I
C
D
1
E
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
R
L
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
is  
a
trademark  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
PR  
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
G
-INCH2  
IN  
OUT  
A
B
C
D
F
I
J
K
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
L
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
A
(
)
SINGLE  
When connecting to other digital audio termi-  
nals or to other analog audio output terminals,  
congure the audio output settings accord-  
ingly using the Audio Output Assign sub-  
menu (See page 91).  
When connecting to other audio ter-  
minals within the same terminal  
section, congure the audio input  
settings accordingly using the  
Audio Assign sub-menu (See page  
94).  
R
L
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
ANALOG  
DIGITAL  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL  
COAXIAL  
MD recorder or CD recorder  
Example for connecting to the TAPE 2 as input  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connection Using the i.LINK (AUDIO) Terminal ( ) (Other than Chinese model)  
What is i.LINK  
i.LINK is an appellation of IEEE1394, which is the digital interface standard dened by the Institute of Electrical and  
Electronics Engineers (IEEE).  
Connecting i.LINK (AUDIO)-supported devices allows high speed transfer of data such as digital sound between the  
linked devices, and their control.  
What is i.LINK (AUDIO)  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E supports i.LINK (AUDIO)of the i.LINK transfer format. Accordingly, i.LINK  
(AUDIO)must also be supported for other devices that you want to connect to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E does not support other i.LINK transfer formats such as MPEG-2 TSused for BS digital  
broadcasts or DVused for DVD recorders, digital video, etc. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E connected to other  
i.LINK(AUDIO)-supported devices via i.LINK cable enables you to transfer multichannel digital sound such as DVD-  
Audio and SACD (video signal is not supported).  
Even when multiple devices are connected to each other, you can perform data transfer and control of target devices via  
another device.  
The IEEE interfaces on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E are designed conforming to the standards below.  
1. IEEE Std 1394a-2000, Standard for a High Performance Serial Bus  
2. IEC60958 bitstream, DVD-Audio, and SACD in the AM824 Sequence adaptation layers of Audio and Music Data  
Transmission Protocol 2.0  
Copyright Protection System  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E supports the DTCP (Digital Transmission Contents Protection) system. The DTCP  
system uses technologies for data encryption and authentication during the data transfer between the i.LINK-con-  
nected digital devices in order to protect the copyright of the content against illegal duplication. To enjoy replaying  
DVD-Audio, etc., the DTCP must also be supported by other devices connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
How to Make a Connection through the i.LINK (AUDIO) Interface  
Use the S400 4-pin i.LINK (AUDIO) cable to connect the i.LINK (AUDIO) terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E to the i.LINK (AUDIO) terminal on the i.LINK (AUDIO)-enabled device.  
When using the i.LINK connection, you need to congure the audio input assignment settings in the i.LINKsec-  
tion of the Audio Assign sub-menu (Some i.LINK-connected devices may require audio output settings).  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E supports only audio signal transmission through the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface.  
When connecting video devices, you need to make a connection using other terminals for video signal.  
Note:  
If any other Onkyo product is connected to the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E via i.LINK, system operation can be achieved via  
i.LINK cable. In that case, disconnect the  
connection as it may  
introduce errors.  
VIDEO OUT  
In addition to the i.LINK  
audio connection,  
make sure to connect  
the terminals for  
images such as VIDEO  
and/or S VIDEO  
terminals.  
COMPONENT  
MULTI  
-INCH1  
F
G
K
J
L
C
D
1
E
AUDIO IN  
L
H
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
I
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
VIDEO  
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
IN 2  
FL  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
4
4
5
6
7
8
PH  
1
1
Y
Y
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
PR  
Y
GND  
PB  
PR  
SL  
R
L
HDMI,  
t
Net-Tune”  
is trademark of  
Onkyo Corporation.  
1
2
3
is tra  
a
a
FM  
75  
or regi  
tradem  
Licens  
OUT  
1
SBR  
SBL  
IN 3  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
PB  
PR  
Y
(
)
Net-Tune  
AM  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
PB  
SL  
1
3
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Interconnection of i.LINK (AUDIO)-supported Devices  
The i.LINK connection allows for data transfer, even if the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is connected to other devices  
via another i.LINK (AUDIO)-supported device. You can connect up to 17 devices in a daisy chain (in-line) connection  
arrangement using the i.LINK connection.  
Example: TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
i.LINK ready DVD player  
i.LINK-ready BS tuner  
... up to 17 devices  
For devices in a branched connection arrangement, you can connect up to 63, as long as they have three or more  
i.LINK (AUDIO) terminals.  
Example: TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
i.LINK-ready DVD player  
i.LINK-ready BS tuner  
... up to 63 devices  
i.LINK-ready MD recorder  
Be sure to avoid the looped connection arrangement of devices as shown below. The output signals should not be  
returned to the original signal output device, which may cause device failure.  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready  
device  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready  
device  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready  
i.LINK (AUDIO)- device  
ready device  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready  
device  
Notes:  
Do not connect any devices that do not support i.LINK (AUDIO), such as MPEG-2 TSready devices used for BS  
digital broadcasts and DVready devices used for digital video, etc.  
Do not connect/disconnect i.LINK cable to or from other devices, connect additional devices, or turn them on/off  
while any i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready device is playing. Otherwise, the audio sound may be interrupted.  
Some i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready devices cannot transfer data when the power mode is set to standby or off. Refer to  
the individual User Manual of the i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready device you want to connect.  
i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready devices have their own maximum data transfer rate: either S100 (100 Mbps*), S200 (200  
Mbps*) or S400 (400 Mbps*). The rate label is located near the i.LINK (AUDIO) terminals. The TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E has a maximum data transfer rate of 400 Mbps. However, this may decrease depending on the speci-  
cations or the maximum data transfer rate of devices connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. It is recom-  
mended to connect devices with the same maximum data transfer rate.  
*Mbpsstands for mega bits per secondwhich indicates the maximum data size transferred per second. For example, 400 Mbps  
indicates that 400 mega bits of data can be transferred every second.  
The i.LINK feature does not assure successful connectivity between all i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready devices. Successful  
data transfer and control signal communications depend on the individual features of each device.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
How to Configure i.LINK Connections  
Selecting a Device  
When the i.LINK connection is ready, you can use the setup menu to select any device which is connected via i.LINK.  
Once you have congured the i.LINK setting, the next time you select the input source, it will be selected as the play-  
ing source.  
Using Remote Control  
1. Press the [INPUT] button, and then turn the scroll wheel to select any source for setting.  
2. Press the scroll wheel, and then press the [SETUP] button.  
3. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Input Setup,and then press the [ENTER] button.  
4. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Audio Assign,and then press the [ENTER] button.  
5. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select g. i.LINK.”  
6. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select any device.  
If you do not want to hear audio sound regardless if the i.LINK connection is ready, select No.”  
Using Control Buttons on TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
1. Select any input source, and then press the [SETUP] button.  
2. Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to select Input Setup,and then press the dial.  
3. Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to select Audio Assign,and then press the dial.  
4. Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to select g. i.LINK,and then press the dial.  
5. Turn the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial to select any device.  
If you do not want to hear audio sound regardless if the i.LINK connection is ready, select No.”  
Using Useful Functions While the i.LINK Connection is Ready  
If any other Onkyo product is connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via i.LINK and assigned as a input source  
(Audio Assign), you can use the following functions. The  
connection must be disconnected to use them.  
i.LINK Selector Change  
When the i.LINK-connected device starts playing, the input source will automatically be changed to the one assigned  
to the device even if another input source has been selected. See page 120 for detailed operations.  
Note:  
You cannot hear audio sound of i.LINK-connected devices in Zone 2.  
Control of DVD Player  
You can control a DVD player by emitting signals from the remote controller to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Auto Start (Wakeup Setup)  
While the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is in standby mode, you can congure the setting of any i.LINK-connected  
device. See page 120 for detailed operations.  
OSD for DVD  
If DVD player is connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via i.LINK, you can output the OSD of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E on a TV, even if a DVD player is directly connected to the TV. You can congure the set-  
ting to specify the display area on the TV, for example, right or left side of the screen. When multiple devices are con-  
nected, you can select any specic device through which the output is sent. This function is also available in Zone 2.  
See page 120 for detailed operations.  
Note:  
While the Intelligent Monitor is used, do not change mode to standby, nor turn on/off the player.  
DVD Output Synchronization  
You can select on/off of the i.LINK (AUDIO) output of a DVD player from the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. See page  
120 for detailed operations.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connection Using HDMI Terminals  
About the HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface)  
The High Denition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) is an interface standard for next-generation TV, designed to connect  
between STB (Set Top Box) and display digitally in the home, responding to technological changes such as digitaliza-  
tion of TV broadcasting.  
*1  
In addition to the existing features provided by the DigitalVisual Interface (DVI) standard, HDMI allows transmission  
of both audio and control signals. Moreover, multiple cables are required for video, audio, and control signals in con-  
ventional connections, but the HDMI interface allows you to make a connection through a single HDMI cable, thus  
enabling transfer of digital video and sound data between HDMI-supported devices.  
In principle, the HDMI video stream (video signals) is compatible with the DVI.You can use the HDMI-DVI conversion  
cables to connect with TVs or monitors that are outtted with DVI terminals, though video images may not be visible  
depending on the combination of devices. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E uses HDCP; you can enjoy pictures on  
HDCP ready monitors.  
The HDMI interfaces on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E are designed to conform to the standards below.  
High-Denition Multimedia Interface Specication Informational Version 1.0  
Copyright Protection System  
*2  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E supports High-bandwidth Digital Contents Protection (HDCP) , technology to pro-  
tect copyright of digital video signals against illegal duplication. HDCP must also be supported on the devices con-  
nected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. Use the HDMI cable supplied with the product or those from the  
marketplace to connect the HDMI OUT terminal on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E with the HDMI input terminals on  
TVs or monitors.  
*3  
*1 DVI (Digital Visual Interface): The digital display interface standard set by DDWG in 1999.  
*2 HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Contents Protection): The video data encryption technology for DVI developed by  
Intel. This technology is designed to protect the video content and a HDCP-compliant DVI receiver is required to  
play the encrypted video content.  
*3 DDWG (Digital Display Working Group): The standardization group for digital interface for display, operated  
mainly by Intel, Silicon Image, FUJITSU, and Hewlett-Packard (Compaq Computer).  
How to Make a Connection through the HDMI Interface  
Use the HDMI cable to connect the HDMI terminals on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and on an HDMI-enabled  
device such as a DVD player, TV, or projector.  
Set HDMI to 1 or 2 in the Video Assign sub-menu according to the connected device you wish to use. In the initial  
settings, 1 is assigned to DVD, and 2 to Video 1.  
Basically, the HDMI can transmit audio signals. However in order to playback the audio signal with the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, make a separate digital connection with a DVD player or other devices, since the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E cannot playback any audio signals supplied from its HDMI IN 1/2 terminals.  
When other input source than 1 or 2 is selected, analog/digital audio signals and analog video signals will be con-  
verted into the HDMI format and output through the HDMI OUT terminal (In the initial settings, no audio signal is  
output. Appropriate setting should be made in the Audio Output Assign sub-menu).  
Analog audio signals will be output in the PCM format. Digital audio signals will be output through the HDMI OUT  
terminal only if the connected TV or projector can playback the digital audio signals.  
A TV or projector that supports PCM audio signals only, for example, cannot playback audio signals in the Dolby  
Digital format supplied as an input source to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. In order to properly playback the audio  
signals in this case, the player should be congured to output the PCM signals.  
When an analog audio connection is made on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, analog audio signal is output in the  
PCM format.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting AV Components—Continued  
Connection example when the source selection is performed on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
DVD Player with HDMI OUTPUT  
ENT  
Y
K
J
L
RS232  
ANTENNA  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
TV or Projector  
Y
IN  
1
PB  
PR  
Y
PB  
PR  
REMOTE  
12V  
CONTROL  
HDMI  
OUT  
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
PB  
PR  
100mA MAX.  
Y
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
PB  
MAIN  
ZONE  
2
3
PR  
Set Top Box with HDMI OUTPUT  
HDMI  
IN  
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
O
IN  
OUT  
J
K
)
E
SURR  
L
SPEAKERS  
A
B
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
Tips:  
SPEAKERS  
To enable HDMI audio output of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E from the  
TV speakers, enable HDMI Out  
according to “HDMI Out” on page  
92.  
HDMI  
OUT  
UDC/UDT  
-
MODEL NO. TX NR1000  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Connection example for higher video quality  
When connecting an AV component equipped with the HDMI input terminal, you can use the connecting layout shown below.  
Before making a connection, read the instruction manual of the connected device thoroughly.  
K
L
RS232  
ANTENNA  
ONENT VIDEO  
IN  
HDMI  
4
TV or Projector  
Y
IN  
1
DVD Player with HDMI  
INPUT and OUTPUT  
PB  
PR  
REMOTE  
12V  
CONTROL  
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
A
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
100mA MAX.  
Y
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
PB  
MAIN  
ZONE  
2
3
PR  
HDMI  
IN  
HDMI  
IN  
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
L
IN  
OUT  
J
K
SURR  
L
SPEAKERS  
A
B
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
SPEAKERS  
HDMI  
OUT  
UDT  
-
MODEL NO. TX NR1000  
Before making a connection, read the  
DVD instruction manual thoroughly.  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Components not Reached by the Remote  
Controller Signals (IR IN/OUT)  
Example for the remote zone (Zone 2/Zone 3)  
The IR IN input allows you to control the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E from the remote zone (Zone 2/Zone 3)  
with the remote controller even though the remote zone  
may be on the other side of the building from the main  
zone. The diagram below shows how to make the proper  
connections for the remote zone.  
In order to use the remote controller to control the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E from a remote location,  
you will need to prepare a multiroom kit (sold sepa-  
rately) such as one listed below:  
Onkyos Multi-Room System kits (IR Remote Con-  
troller Extension System)  
Multiroom A/V distribution and control system such  
®
®
as those from Niles and Xantech  
To IR IN  
RF Receivers can also be used with the remote controller  
to control the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E from a remote  
location. To use RF Receivers, set the Transmission Sig-  
nal Format setting to RF(See page 141 for details).  
IR Receiver  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
Connecting  
block  
If Remote Controller Signal Does not  
Reach the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Remote Sensor  
Remote controller  
Effective Sensor Layout  
Main room  
Zone 2/Zone 3 room  
: Signal ow  
Example for the main room  
If the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is located inside a  
cabinet or other enclosure where the infrared rays from the  
remote controller cannot enter, then operation with the  
remote controller will not be possible. In such a case, it will  
be necessary to install a remote sensor at a location outside  
of the cabinet so that the infrared rays from the controller  
can be sensed.  
Making Sensor Connections  
When you place the IR receiver in the main room,  
connect the cable from the connecting block to the IR IN  
MAIN terminal. When you place the IR receiver in the  
remote zone, connect the cable from the connecting  
block to the ZONE 2 or ZONE 3 terminal accordingly.  
Make the connection as shown below. Do not plug any  
equipment into the power outlet until all the connections  
are complete.  
IR Receiver  
Connecting  
block  
IR IN  
from connecting block  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Mini plug cable  
TX-NR  
1000/  
TX-NR  
5000E  
Remote controller  
In the  
cabinet  
Main room  
: Signal ow  
MAIN  
ZONE  
2
3
ZONE  
IR  
IN  
OUT  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting Components not  
Reached by the Remote Controller  
Signals (IR IN/OUT)—Continued  
Using an External  
Device with 12VTrigger  
Terminal  
If Remote Controller Signal Does not  
Reach Other Components  
You can automatically turn on the connected AV com-  
ponents with the output signal from the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es 12V TRIGGER OUT terminal.  
Effective Sensor Layout  
Making a Connection  
In this situation, you will need to use a commercially  
available IR emitter. Connect the mini plug of the IR  
emitter to the IR OUT terminal on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E and then place the IR emitter on the  
remote sensor of the component or facing it. When the  
IR emitter is connected, only the signal input to the IR  
IN terminal is output to the IR OUT terminal. The sig-  
nal input from the remote sensor on the front of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will not be output to the IR  
OUT terminal.  
Connect the 12V TRIGGER OUT terminal on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to the 12V TRIGGER IN  
terminal on other components. Every 12V TRIGGER  
OUT terminal can be connected to the components  
whether they are placed in the main room, Zone 2, or  
Zone 3.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E has ve 12V TRIG-  
GER OUT terminals and the maximum currents to be  
connected are as follows:  
A: 200 mA  
B, C, D and E: 100 mA  
After making connections, congure the association  
between the room (zone) and the component to be  
turned on (Refer to 12V Trigger Assignunder Input  
Setupon page 98).  
IR Receiver  
Connecting  
block  
IR IN  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
IR OUT  
IR Emitter  
Remote controller  
Other  
component  
: Signal ow  
Device A  
12V TRIGGER  
IN  
200mA MAX.  
Making Sensor Connections  
When you place the IR receiver in the main room, con-  
nect the cable from the connecting block to the IR OUT  
MAIN terminal. When you place the IR receiver in the  
remote zone, connect the cable from the connecting  
block to the ZONE 2 or ZONE 3 terminal accordingly.  
Other component  
12V  
TRIGGER  
OUT  
A
200mA MAX.  
Device B  
B
D
100mA MAX.  
100mA MAX.  
12V TRIGGER  
IN  
C
100mA MAX.  
100mA MAX.  
E
100mA MAX.  
: Signal ow  
Remote control  
sensor  
Device C  
Device D  
Device E  
12V TRIGGER  
IN  
100mA MAX.  
Mini plug  
Emitter  
IR Emitter  
MAIN  
12V TRIGGER  
IN  
ZONE  
2
3
100mA MAX.  
ZONE  
IR  
IN  
OUT  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
12V TRIGGER  
IN  
100mA MAX.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting -compatible AV Components  
The  
terminal on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is  
Connections for Remote Control (  
)
for connecting other Onkyo components equipped with  
the same  
to the  
terminal. When a component is connected  
terminal, it can be operated by the remote  
To connect components using the  
connect a remote control cable from this  
the terminal of the other component. An  
control cable with a 1/8 inch (3.5 mm) miniature two-  
conductor plug comes with every cassette tape deck,  
compact disc player, MD recorder, and DVD player that  
terminal, simply  
terminal to  
remote  
controller supplied with the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
In addition, when you connect a component to the  
terminal, you can also perform the system operations  
given below.  
has an  
When performing operations with  
components using the system, do not use the  
terminal.  
Power on/ready function  
When the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is in the standby  
-connected  
state, if an  
-connected component is turned on, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E also turns on and the input  
source selected at the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
automatically switches to that component.  
remote zone (Zone 2/Zone3).  
For remote control operation, the audio connection  
cables must also be connected.  
Be aware that this function will not work if the power cord  
If a component has two  
terminals, you can use  
for the  
-connected component is connected to the AC  
either one to connect to the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. The other one can be used to daisy  
chain with another component.  
OUTLET on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, or if the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E has already been turned on.  
Direct change function  
When the play button is pressed on an  
component, the input source selected at the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E automatically changes to  
that component.  
With Onkyo DVD players, you can enter the pre-  
program code so that you can operate the DVD player  
directly with the remote controller without connecting  
-connected  
the  
terminals (See page 129).  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
Power off function  
REMOTE  
CONTROL  
When the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is placed in the  
standby state, all  
-connected components are also  
automatically put into the standby state.  
Also, if you press the [ON] button on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E remote controller while the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E is turned on, all  
-connected  
connector  
components (DVD players, CD players, MD recorders,  
tuners, etc.) are also turned on.  
Ex: Onkyo CD player  
connector  
REMOTE  
CONTROL  
Onkyo DVD player  
Ex: Onkyo cassette tape  
deck  
L
R
Remote control cable  
ANALOG  
OUTPUT  
Remote  
control  
cable  
AUDIO IN  
REMOTE  
R
L
CONTROL  
4
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
IN 2  
MULTI  
F
G
J
K
L
C
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
D
1
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
E
AUDIO IN  
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
I
-
ICNH1  
IN  
1
R
L
R
L
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
RS232  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
ANTENNA  
HDMI  
4
PH  
4
5
6
7
8
1
Y
1
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
P
B
R
GND  
P
B
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
CONTROL  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
12V  
1
2
3
P
is  
a
trademark  
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
SBR  
SBL  
OUT  
1
IN 3  
A
P
R
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
Y
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
P
P
B
R
100mA MAX.  
Y
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
P
B
MAIN  
SL  
1
3
4
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
P
R
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
MULTI  
G
-
ICNH2  
IN  
OUT  
C
D
F
I
J
K
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
SINGLE  
L
SURR  
L
(
)
SPEAKERS  
A
B
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
SPEAKERS  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
L
(BTL)  
UDC/UDT  
-
MODEL NO. TX NR1000  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Operation of Remote Controller Buttons  
The remote controller supplied with the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is a multifunctional remote controller, so you can  
operate not only the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E but also AV components connected to the apparatus and components  
placed in another room. The basic operations are explained here. It is recommended that you read and understand this  
page before starting actual operations. This explanation focuses on remote controller operations.  
To Operate the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E (AMP Mode)  
Press the scroll wheel.  
1
ON  
STANDBY  
Indication on the lower  
line changes to AMP.  
TV  
ON,  
I
INPUT  
STANDBY  
+
TV CH  
-
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
@.  
-
'/  
4
5
6
When the remote controller is in AMP  
mode, the following functions are  
available:  
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
2
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ON/STANDBY: Press to set power on/standby.  
MAIN A: Used when driving the speaker that  
has been set to Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
Scroll wheel  
DIMMER  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
MAIN B: Used when driving the speaker that  
has been set to Main Bin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
DIMMER: Used when changing brightness of  
the display window.  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
DISPLAY  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
VOL /  
-
PREV  
CH  
SETUP/  
ENTER/  
RETURN/  
Cursor  
MUTING  
SETUP/RETURN/ENTER/Cursor  
/
/
/
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
): Used when operating the setup menu.  
DISPLAY: Used when switching the display.  
THX/SURR/PURE A/DIRECT/ALL ST/  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
/
/
/
MAIN A/  
STEREO/DSP  
/
: Used when switching the  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
-
ALL ST  
MAIN B  
listening mode.  
SURR, THX,  
ALL ST,  
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
TEST TONE/CH SEL/LEVEL–/+: Used for  
the test tone, or when temporarily changing the  
sound volume level.  
AUDIO SEL: Used when switching the sound  
signal.  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
TEST TONE,  
CH SEL,  
LEVEL /+  
-
+
TEST  
T
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
STEREO,  
PURE A,  
DIRECT,  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
DSP  
/
SLEEP: Used when setting the sleep timer.  
AUDIO SEL  
L NIGHT,  
Re-EQ  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
VOL  
: Used when adjusting the sound  
volume.  
MUTING: Used to temporarily turn off the  
sound immediatedly.  
L NIGHT: Used when switching the dynamic range.  
Re-EQ: Used when applying the Re-EQ effect.  
To Select an Input Source  
Press the [INPUT] button.  
The [INPUT] button lights.  
1
2
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
Roll the scroll wheel.  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
4
5
6
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
Indication on the  
7
8
9
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
upper line changes.  
TV VOL  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
When you perform the procedures on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, use the input source buttons on the front  
panel.  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Operation of Remote Controller Buttons—Continued  
To Operate a Connected Component (Mode Switching)  
Press the [MODE] button.  
The [MODE] button lights.  
1
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
Roll the scroll wheel.  
@.  
-
'/  
2
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
Indication on the lower line  
changes to indicate the  
selected component mode.  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
/
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
Before operating the connected component, follow the  
instructions on pages 124 through 133 to make  
appropriate settings using the remote controller.  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
To Select a Source in Zone 2 or Zone 3  
Press the [ZONE 2] or [ZONE 3] button.  
The [ZONE 2] or [ZONE 3] button lights.  
1
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
Roll the scroll wheel.  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
2
@.  
-
'/  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
Indication on the upper  
line changes to indicate  
the selected input.  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
/
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
ZONE 3  
ZONE 2  
MACRO  
When you perform the procedures on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, press the [ZONE 2] (or [REC/ZONE  
3]), and turn the [SELECT/PRESET] (or [CONTROL/  
TUNING]).  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
To Perform a Macro Operation  
Before performing the following procedure, complete  
your macro settings (See page 137).  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
Press the [MACRO] button.  
The [MACRO] button lights.  
1
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
8
9
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the macros  
number, and then press the scroll wheel.  
TV VOL  
2
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
MACRO  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
CustomizingYour Remote Controller  
Use the [CUSTOM] button to enter the remote controller code for another apparatus to this remote controller,” “to  
make this remote controller learn specied operations from the remote controller for another apparatus,or to make  
this remote controller learn a series of operations with macro functionsaccording to the conguration you are using.  
For detailed information, see pages 136-142.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations  
Before you plug in the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, conrm that all connections have been made properly.  
Turning on the power may cause a momentary power surge, which might interfere with other electrical equipment  
on the same circuit, such as computers. If this happens, use a wall outlet on a different circuit.  
(All models other than USA, Canadian, and Australian models)  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is shipped with the main power (POWER) switch in the on position (  
). When  
ON  
the power cord is plugged in for the rst time, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will automatically enter the standby  
state and the [STANDBY] indicator will light (same condition after step 2 below on the left coloumn).  
Input source buttons  
Input source buttons  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY indicator  
STANDBY indicator  
MASTER VOLUME  
MASTER VOLUME  
MASTER VOLUME  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
STANDBY  
POWER  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
(
BLUE  
2
(
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
ON  
OFF  
PURE AUDIO  
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
7
INPUT  
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
L
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
MEMORY  
RT/PTY/TP  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
To wall outlet  
To wall outlet  
POWER  
(Other models)  
(USA, Canadian, and Australian models)  
Turning on the Power  
Operating on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
Plug the power cord into an AC  
wall outlet.  
1
Select an input source.  
Press the input source button.  
*You cannot listen to a source in main  
room A, and to another source in main  
room B.  
1
(USA, Canadian, and Australian  
models)  
DISPLAY  
TAPE  
CD  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
NET AUDIO  
The [STANDBY] indicator will light up.  
POWER  
DVD  
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
3
7
(Other models)  
VIDEO  
4
5
6
Press the [POWER] switch to set  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to  
standby state.  
ON  
OFF  
STANDBY  
The [STANDBY] indicator will light up.  
Start playing the device selected.  
2
3
When playing a picture device such as a  
DVD player, you need to switch input to  
a monitor such a TV set.  
Some picture-playing devices such as a  
DVD-type game machine may also  
require setting of sound output. Refer to  
the manual of the device connected.  
Press the [STANDBY/ON] button  
to turn on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
The display will light up and the  
[STANDBY] indicator will turn off.  
If you press the [STANDBY/ON] button  
again, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
returns to the standby state.  
2
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
Turn off  
Adjust the volume level with the  
[MASTER VOLUME] dial.  
You can adjust the volume level in the  
range from , 81.5 dB to 18.0 dB  
(Max) (when Relative is selected in the  
Volume Setup sub-menu).  
Note:  
Any components connected via  
on when the remote controllers [ON] button is pressed.  
MASTER VOLUME  
will also be turned  
Hint:  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is a product  
for users to enjoy home theater, so it is  
equipped with a wide range of volume  
levels. Please ne tune the volume level  
aaccording to your preferences.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations—Continued  
Operating with Remote Controller  
Press the button for the room  
where you want to play your  
device.  
MAIN A: Switches to operations in  
main room A.  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
1
TV  
ON  
I
INPUT  
STANDBY  
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
MAIN B: Switches to operations in  
main room B.  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
/
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
When MAIN A or MAIN B is selected,  
the indicator on the front display of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E lights.  
If the mode is already effective, you do  
not need to press. If you press this but-  
ton, the mode is made becomes ineffec-  
tive.  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
MODE  
INPUT  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
The speaker set in the Speaker/Output  
Setup menu sounds in the room selected.  
CH  
VOL  
/
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
Roll the scroll wheel to select a  
device to play.  
2
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
Carry out this operation when neither the  
[MODE] button nor the [INPUT] button  
lights. If any button lights, press it to turn  
it off.  
Rolling the scroll wheel lights both but-  
tons, and switches the input source and  
the mode at the same time.  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
MAIN B  
MAIN A  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
REPEAT  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Start playing the device selected.  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
3
4
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
When playing a picture device such as a  
DVD player, you need to switch the  
input to a monitor such as TV set.  
Some picture-playing devices such as a  
DVD-type game machine may also  
require setting of sound output. Refer to  
the manual of the device connected.  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
Turning on the Power from the  
Remote Controller  
Adjust the volume level with the  
[VOL  
] button.  
Before you can use the remote controller, you must  
perform steps 1 and 2 in the Turning on the Power”  
section and place the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E in the  
standby state.  
You can adjust the volume level in the  
range from , 81.5 dB to 18.0 dB  
(Max) (when Relative is selected in the  
Volume Setup sub-menu).  
VOL  
Press the scroll wheel.  
Hint:  
1
AMPappears on the remote  
controllers display. This is the mode for  
controlling the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is a  
product for users to enjoy the home  
theater, so it is equipped with a wide  
range of volume levels. Please ne-tune  
the volume level according to you  
preferences.  
Press the [ON] button to turn on  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
2
ON  
To set the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to  
Standby, press the [STANDBY] button.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations—Continued  
Adjusting the Brightness of the Front Display  
TONE  
You can adjust the brightness of the front display of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E using the [DIMMER]  
button on the remote controller or on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E front panel (other than European  
models).  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
TX-NR1000/  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
Use the [DIMMER] button on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to select:  
normal, dark, very dark, and  
volume only.  
TX-NR5000E  
DIMMER  
PHONES  
DIMMER  
CONTROL/TUNING  
SELECT/PRESET  
Remote  
controller  
On the remote controller,press the  
scroll wheel, and then press the  
[DIMMER] button.  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
2
ABC  
3
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
4
5
6
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
INPUT  
7
8
9
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
DIMMER  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
Scroll wheel  
Temporarily Turning Off the Sound (remote  
controller only)  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
DIMMER  
TV  
INPUT  
+
Use the [MUTING] button to temporarily turn off the  
sound immediately.  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
Remote  
controller  
Press the scroll wheel, and then  
press the [MUTING] button on the  
MUTING  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
remote controller.  
Listening with Headphones  
When pressed, Mutingis displayed on  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. Press  
the [MUTING] button again to turn the  
sound back on.  
To listen with headphones, plug a pair of headphones  
with a standard stereo plug into the PHONES jack on  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E front panel.  
MUTING  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
PHONES  
FM MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
CLEAR  
Adjust the Tone  
You can adjust bass, mid, and treble notes for each  
speaker set. You can also adjust the tone using the setup  
menu (see page 118).  
When you connect headphones, no sound will be  
heard from the speakers.  
Press the [TONE] button.  
While the Dolby Headphone feature is active,  
appears on the front display.  
Refer to pages 58, 59, and 117.  
1
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
TONE  
Note:  
The signal to the remote zone (Zone 2/3) will not be  
affected whether or not headphones are connected.  
Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to  
select the channel and tone you  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
want to adjust.  
Turn the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial  
to adjust the tone.  
3
CONTROL/TUNING  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations—Continued  
Temporarily Changing the Speaker Output  
Levels (remote controller only)  
MACRO  
ZONE  
2
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
To change the individual speaker volumes temporarily,  
follow the procedure given below. Each channel can be  
set between 12 and +12 decibels (between 15 and  
+12 decibels for the subwoofer). Note that the speaker  
volumes will return to the original settings when the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is put in the standby state.  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
Press the scroll wheel to enter the  
AMP mode.  
1
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
CH SEL  
LEVEL–  
LEVEL+  
-
+
LEVEL  
TEST  
T
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Press the [CH SEL] button and  
select the desired speaker.  
-
2
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
CH SEL  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
Press the [LEVEL ] or [LEVEL +]  
button to adjust the volume level.  
3
-
+
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
Using the Sleep Timer (remote controller only)  
With the sleep timer you can set the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E so that it automatically turns off after a  
set period.  
Note:  
You cannot select a speaker if it is set to Not Usedin  
the Speaker Conguration Sub-menu of the Speaker/  
Output Setup Menu.  
Press the scroll wheel, and then  
press the [SLEEP] button repeat-  
edly to select the required sleep  
time.  
Remote  
controller  
You can set the sleep time from 90 to 10  
minutes in 10 minute increments.  
The [SLEEP] indicator appears on the  
display when the sleep timer has been  
set, as shown. The specied sleep time  
appears on the display for about ve  
seconds, then the previous display  
reappears.  
SLEEP  
Note:  
If you are using the remote zone (Zone 2  
or 3), it will turn off at the same time as  
the main zone.  
To cancel the sleep timer, press the  
[SLEEP] button repeatedly until the  
[SLEEP] indicator disappears.  
To check the remaining sleep time,  
press the [SLEEP] button. Note that if  
you press the [SLEEP] button while the  
sleep time is being displayed, youll  
shorten the sleep time by 10 minutes.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations—Continued  
When an input source other than FM or AM is selected:  
MASTER VOLUME  
Input  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
Program format*  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
EXIT  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
Custom name  
Listening mode  
DISPLAY  
+
-- ---  
/
CL
10  
0
* When the input signal is digital audio other than  
PCM  
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
The program format is displayed. For example, the dis-  
play Dolby D: 3/2.1shows that the format is Dolby  
Digital with 5.1 discrete channels consisting of three  
front channels (front left, front right, and center), two  
surround channels (surround left and surround right),  
and the low frequency effect (LFE) channel.  
MACRO  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
When the front channel number is 2, they are the front left  
and front right; when it is 1, it is monaural. When the sur-  
round channel number is 1, it is monaural; when it is 0,  
there is no surround channel. When no LFE number is  
given, there is no LFE channel. Also, if there is no program  
format for the input signal, nothing will be displayed.  
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
When the input signal is linear PCM  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST  
TO  
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
The sampling frequency is displayed. For example, the  
display PCM fs: 44.1kshows that the signal is PCM  
and that the sampling frequency is 44.1 kHz.  
Re-EQ  
L NIGHT  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
AUDIO SEL  
Dialog norm  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
Dialogue Normalization (Dialog Norm) is a feature of  
Dolby Digital. When playing back software that has  
been encoded in Dolby Digital, sometimes you may see  
a brief message in the front panel display that reads  
Dialog Norm xdB (xbeing a numeric value).  
Dialogue Normalization serves to let you know if the  
source material has been recorded at a higher or lower  
level than usual. For example, if you see the message  
Dialog Norm: +4in the front panel display, to keep  
the overall output level constant the output volume has  
been automatically decreased by 4 dB. In other words,  
the source material that you are listening to has been  
recorded 4 dB louder than usual.  
Switching the Display  
While listening to or watching an input source, you can  
display information regarding the type of source and sig-  
nal being input.  
TX-NR1000/  
Press the [DISPLAY] button on the  
TX-NR5000E  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
DISPLAY  
On the remote controller,press the  
Remote  
scroll wheel, and then press the  
controller  
[DISPLAY] button.  
When FM or AM is selected as the input source:  
Custom  
name  
Preset  
no.  
Listening  
mode  
DISPLAY  
FM/AM +  
Frequency  
Preset  
no.  
Listening  
mode  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Power/Basic Operations—Continued  
Changing the Audio Mode  
Using the Re-EQ Function  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E accepts analog, digital,  
i.LINK (AUDIO), and multichannel signals for audio  
input.You can choose the kind of signal to be played for  
a specic device. For Zone 2, the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E accepts only analog and digital signals  
for audio input.  
This function corrects soundtracks with a strong treble  
level to the home theater level. This correction should  
be made when the treble sounds from the front speakers  
are too strong.  
Hint:  
This can also be set on the menu with OSD. The listening  
mode which the Re-EQ effect can be applied to has a  
Re-EQ option in the Listening Mode Setup menu.  
Press the [INPUT] button,and then  
1
INPUT  
roll the scroll wheel to select the  
input source you want to set.  
Press the scroll wheel, and then  
press the [Re-EQ] button (repeat-  
edly).  
1
-
Re EQ  
Press the scroll wheel and then  
press the [AUDIO SEL] button.  
2
Each time the button is pressed, the  
mode changes from Auto→  
AnalogMultichi.LINKand  
back to Auto.The Autoaudio mode  
is recommended for normal  
Using the Late Night Function  
(only in Dolby Digital)  
The difference between loud and quiet sounds is very  
large in pictures produced for movie theaters, so you  
have to raise the volume level to catch environmental  
sounds and human conversations. Since the Late Night  
Function is able to reduce the difference between loud  
and quiet sounds, you can hear quiet sounds without  
raising the entire volume level. This function is helpful  
when you enjoy movies late at night by turning down  
sounds.  
AUDIO SEL  
circumstances.  
Note:  
This procedure can also be performed by  
using the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Press the [AUDIO SELECTOR] button  
then use the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to  
select the mode you want to set.  
This function is released when putting the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E into the standby status.  
Auto (XXX) (automatic detection): With this setting,  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E automatically detects  
whether the input signal is digital or analog. When a  
digital signal is not input, then the analog signal is  
played. This setting only appears if a digital input is  
selected for the Digital Input setting at Setup Menu →  
Input Setup Menu Audio Assign Sub-menu →  
Digital Audio (See page 95). (XXX) displays the name  
of the assigned terminal.  
Multich (Multichannel): Select this setting to play  
back the input from the component connected to the  
MULTI-CH IN 1/2 port. This setting only appears if 1”  
or 2is selected for the Multichannel setting at Setup  
Menu Input Setup Menu Audio Assign Sub-  
menuMultichannel (See page 94).  
Hint:  
This function can also be set on the menu with OSD  
(See page 106).  
Press the scroll wheel, and then  
press the [L NIGHT] button  
(repeatedly).  
Off: Turns off the Late Night function.  
Low: Reduces the difference between  
loud and quiet sounds.  
1
L NIGHT  
High: Further reduces the difference  
between loud and quiet sounds.  
The previous display comes back after a  
while.  
Analog: Select this setting to playback the input from a  
source component connected to analog audio input  
jacks. With this setting, even if a digital signal is input  
from the same component, only the analog signal will  
be output.  
i.LINK: Select this setting to play back the input from a  
source component connected to the i.LINK (AUDIO)  
terminal. With this setting, only the i.LINK signal will  
be output. This settings is available when any device is  
selected at Input Setup menu Audio Assign Sub-  
menu i.LINK.  
Notes:  
The Late Night function is effective  
only for Dolby Digital sources.  
The Late Night function may be less  
effective or have no effect depending  
on the Dolby Digital source.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Listening Modes  
Types of Listening Modes  
• PLIIx Game  
This is the best mode for enjoying games, providing  
the best sense of signal movement.  
Listening modes on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
enable you to enjoy movie theater or concert hall qual-  
ity sounds in your room. The TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E provides the following listening modes.  
Before playing a source in optimal sound, be sure to  
complete the Speaker/Output Setup (See pages 88 - 91).  
Dolby Digital  
This is a surround mode that will make you feel as if  
you are sitting in a seat inside a theater or concert hall.  
This mode can be used with DVDs and LDs with the  
mark.  
Dolby VS (Dolby Virtual Speaker)  
Direct  
The dynamic surround sound effects specic to 5.1  
channel speakers are reproduced through 2 speakers.  
When combined with Dolby Pro Logic II/DTS  
NEO:6,this mode provides 5.1 channel surround  
music recorded in 2 channels on CD or MP3 through  
only 2 speakers. This mode can also be applied to a sys-  
tem equipped with more than 2 speakers.  
If you are able to use only 2 speakers in a separate room  
(Zone 2 or Zone 3) or main room B, this mode will let  
you experience truly powerful sounds of a movie, CD or  
game through the virtual surround effects. When you  
use this mode with three or more speakers, the speakers  
used for output will depend on the input source and  
decoding mode.  
This mode allows you to enjoy pure sounds straight from  
an original source. Every channel of the audio input  
source will be output as isto respective channels.  
Pure Audio  
In addition to the Direct mode, playback of music more  
faithful to the original sounds is enabled because the  
display window is turned off to minimize noise sources  
(the power supply to the video circuitry is also turned  
off, so nothing is displayed on the screen).  
Stereo  
Sounds are output from the right and left front speakers,  
and the subwoofer.  
Dolby Digital EX/Dolby EX  
Mono  
This mode enables 6.1 channel playback of music or  
movies recorded in 5.1 channels. Adding a surround  
channel to the backside of 5.1 channel speakers to make  
them 6.1 channel speakers will enhance space expres-  
sions that should give you a real feel of moving sounds  
such as 360-degree rotation or overhead ying. Since  
sounds on the surround back channel are divided into  
the surround left and right channels, this mode also  
enables conventional 5.1 channel playback. When play-  
ing DVDs and LDs recorded in 5.1 channels with the  
This mode is suitable for playing old movies recorded  
in monaural sound, or for playing the right and left  
channels separately on bilingual sources. This mode  
also allows you to listen to multiplexed soundtracks on  
DVDs and other sources.  
Dolby Pro Logic II  
This mode enables 5.1-channel playback of music and  
movies recorded in 2 channels.You can select the Movie  
mode, best designed for playing movies, the Music  
mode, best designed for listening to music, and the  
Game mode, best suited for enjoying games.  
• PLII Movie  
This mode can be used with VHS and DVD videos  
with the  
programs.  
• PLII Music  
mark, Dolby Digital EX mode turns on, and when  
playing other sources, Dolby EX turns on.  
DTS  
Sound data that would be of tremendous size if com-  
pletely divided into 5.1 channels are compressed into  
digital data with a status as close as possible to the orig-  
inal sounds. Playing in this mode requires a DVD player  
able to output DTS. This mode can be used with CDs,  
mark, and certain television  
This mode can be used with stereo music CDs and  
DVD recordings of live concerts.  
• PLII Game  
DVDs and LDs with the  
DTS 96/24  
This is a listening mode available with DTS 96/24. This  
mode allows you to enjoy delicate sounds.  
mark.  
This mode can be used with game discs.  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
DTS-ES Discrete  
This mode reproduces in 5.1-7.1 channels music CDs  
and movies recorded in 2 channels. Together with  
clearer sounds, you will hear more natural and smoother  
surround effects than ever before. In addition to CDs  
and movies, game sources are played with a dramatic  
spatial presentation and with sound localization.  
And this mode enables 7.1 channel playback of music  
and movies recorded in 5.1 channels. You can select the  
PLIIx Movie and PLIIx Music mode.  
This is a 6.1 channel surround system based on DTS  
with a surround back channel added. Since all 6.1 chan-  
nels including the added surround back channel are  
recorded as completely independent digital data, a 3-D  
feeling and a sense of moving sounds are reproduced  
more clearly. This mode can be used with CDs, DVDs,  
and LDs with the  
mark.  
• PLIIx Movie  
This is the best mode for viewing movies.  
• PLIIx Music  
This is the best mode for playing music.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Listening Modes—Continued  
DTS-ES Matrix  
• THX Games Mode  
This mode plays in 6.1 channels the music and movies  
recorded in DTS-ES. Sources recorded in DTS-ES  
include data for the surround back channel, and each  
channel is reproduced in 6.1 channels. This mode can  
This is the THX Ultra 2 mode designed for playing  
game sources.  
• THX Surround EX  
“THX Surround EX” - Dolby Digital Surround EX is  
a joint development of Dolby Laboratories and the  
THX Ltd.  
In a movie theater, film soundtracks that have been  
encoded with Dolby Digital Surround EX technology  
are able to reproduce an extra surround back channel  
which has been added during the mixing of the pro-  
gram. A list of Surround EX encoded movies can be  
found on www.Dolby.com.  
be used with CDs, DVDs, and LDs with the  
mark.  
DTS NEO:6  
This mode enables 6.1 channel playback of music and  
movies recorded in 2 channels. A broad frequency band  
is allocated to each channel, and every channel is kept  
very independent. This mode can be set to the Cinema  
mode, best designed for playing movies, and the Music  
mode, best designed for listening to music.  
The sources recorded in 5.1 channels are played in  
NEO:6.  
• Multichannel  
This is a listening mode available with analog multi-  
channel connection.  
• i.LINK: DVD-Audio  
• NEO:6 Cinema  
This is a listening mode used for playing DVD-Audio  
format sources during i.LINK (AUDIO) connection.  
• i.LINK: SACD  
This is a listening mode used for playing Super Audio  
CD format sources during i.LINK (AUDIO) connec-  
tion.  
Surround effects full of moving sound feelings are  
reproduced. This mode is suitable for 2 channel  
recorded VHS videos, DVD videos, and television  
programs.  
• NEO:6 Music  
Since it uses a surround channel, this mode creates a  
natural sound field, which cannot be expected from  
ordinary 2 channel output. This mode is suitable for  
playing CDs recorded in 2 channels.  
Onkyo’s Proprietary Listening Mode (DSP)  
All Ch Stereo  
This mode is useful for playing music as BGM. Stereo  
sounds are provided by all speakers, so you can enjoy a  
powerful sound field.  
AAC  
Digital data compressed through the MPEG-2 AAC sys-  
tem reproduces surround sounds of 5.1 channels at  
maximum. This mode can be used for playing AAC  
sources such as a BS-digital-broadcasted program.  
Full Mono  
Monaural sounds are provided by all speakers. You can  
listen to the same tone of music wherever you are.  
Multiplex  
Mono Movie  
This mode is used for listening to multiplex broadcasts.  
This mode is suitable for playing old movies recoreded  
in with monaural sound. The center channel outputs  
straight sounds, while other speakers provide center  
sounds with adequate echo effects. Despite monaural  
sound, you can enjoy the feeling of being in a movie the-  
ater.  
THX  
This mode produces the maximum effects on a THX-  
compliant speaker system.  
• THX Cinema  
This is a 5.1 channel THX mode, designed for view-  
ing theatrical films recorded and edited on the  
assumption that they will be played in a sizable place  
like a movie theater. The audio output for the sur-  
round back channels depends on the input source and  
decoding mode.  
Enhance  
This mode is suitable for playig music, and watching  
sports programs on television. Environmental sounds  
are move naturally to the surround and surround back  
speakers, so more dynamic sounds are reproduced.  
• THX Ultra2 Cinema  
Orchestra  
This is the THX Ultra 2 mode. This mode enables 7.1  
channel playback of music and movies recorded in  
5.1 channels. It analyzes surround factors to be repro-  
duced, and distributes the factors to the surround back  
to optimize the atmosphere and the sense of orienta-  
tion. This function reinforces the horizontal and back-  
ward extension, and the sound location.  
• THX Music Mode  
This mode is suitable for playing classical music and  
operas. The surround effects are reinforced to extend the  
sound image throughout the listening room. You can  
enjoy the natural touch of music as if you are sitting in a  
large concert hall.  
Unplugged  
This mode is suitable for listening to acoustic sounds,  
vocals and jazz music. Because it focuses on the front  
sound image, this mode creates an image of the sound  
field that makes you feel as if you are listening to music  
in front of a stage.  
This is the THX Ultra 2 mode designed for playing  
music sources. It enables 7.1 channel playback of 5.1  
channel recorded sources.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Listening Modes—Continued  
TV Logic  
This mode is suitable for television programs broadcast  
from studios. You may feel as if you are sitting in a tele-  
vision studio. All of the surround sounds are enhanced,  
and conversations are output clearly.  
Listening Modes for Listeners Using  
Headphones  
Dolby Headphone  
This mode makes headphones reproduce dynamic sur-  
round sound effects like 5.1 channel speakers. The lis-  
tening mode used before putting on headphones is  
applied to the headphones. However, the following lis-  
tening modes will be decoded as follows:  
The Dolby VS or Stereo mode sources will be  
decoded in the Dolby Headphone mode.  
The source decoded in the 7.1ch surround format will  
be decoded in the 5.1ch surround format.  
The DTS 96/24 mode source will be decoded in the  
DTS format.  
Listening modes when the Dolby Headphone is set to  
“Off”:  
Direct  
When the listening mode was Direct before putting on  
headphones, this mode is applied. Effects are the same  
as the Direct mode indicated previously.  
Pure Audio  
When the listening mode was Pure Audio before putting  
on headphones, this mode is applied. Effects are the  
same as the Pure Audio indicated previously.  
Mono  
When the listening mode was Mono, Mono Movie or  
Full Mono before putting on headphones, this mode is  
applied. Effects are the same as the Mono mode indi-  
cated previously.  
This mode is also applied when you listen to the monau-  
ral source in the Dolby VS listening mode before put-  
ting on headphones.  
Stereo  
When the listening mode was other than Direct, Pure  
Audio, Mono, Mono Movie or Full Mono before put-  
ting on headphones, this mode is applied. Effects are the  
same as the Stereo mode indicated previously.  
Multiplex  
When the listening mode was Multiplex before putting  
on headphones, this mode is applied.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Listening Modes—Continued  
Selecting the Listening Mode  
Start playback on the device you selected  
for input.  
2
3
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E provides various listen-  
ing modes.  
Press the scroll wheel, and then press the  
listening mode button you want to select.  
PURE A button: To switch the listening mode to  
Pure Audio.When you select PURE AUDIO,”  
the video signal is interrupted (resulting in a  
blacked-out screen), and the [PURE AUDIO]  
indicator lights up.  
Note:  
The available modes depend on the input signal you  
selected.  
Input source buttons  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
DIRECT button: To switch the listening mode  
STANDBY  
to Direct.”  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
STEREO button: To switch the listening mode to  
Stereo.”  
SURR button: To switch the listening mode to the  
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
surround mode.  
When 5 channel signals are input, every time  
you press the button, the listening mode  
LISTENING MODE SELECT/PRESET  
changes DolbyEXPLIIx Movie  
(Default)PLIIx MusicNEO:6→  
OffDolbyEX,and so on.  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
INPUT  
1
2
ABC  
3
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
When 2 channel signals are input, every time  
you press the button, the listening mode  
changes PLIIx Movie (Default)PLIIx  
MusicPLIIx GameNEO:6 Cinema”  
NEO:6 MusicPLIIx Movie  
(Default),and so on.  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
/
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
THX button: To switch the listening mode to  
THX.”  
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
When Dolby Digital multichannel (*/2) signals  
are input, you can switch to any of the following  
decode modes. Every time you press the button,  
the listening mode changes THX Cinema→  
SurroundEXUltra2 Cinema (Default)→  
MusicModeGames ModeTHX Cin-  
ema,and so on (See page 112).  
DSP/DSP buttons: Every time you press  
the buttons, you can switch to any of the listening  
modes according to the input signals.  
ALL ST button: To switch the listening mode to  
All Ch Stereo.”  
ALL ST  
THX  
SURR  
DIRECT  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
STEREO  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
REPEAT  
A-B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
PURE A  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Re-EQ  
L
NIGHT  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
Operating on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
[
]/[ ] cursor buttons:  
Press the input source button.  
1
When AACs multiplex sound signals are  
input, the main-sound and sub-sound are  
switched. Every time you press the [ ]/[  
Start playback on the device you selected  
for input.  
2
]
buttons, the mode changes MainSub”  
Main + SubMain,and so on.  
When using the headphones, you can use the  
Press the [LISTENING MODE] button, and  
then turn the [SELECT/PRESET] to select  
a listening mode.  
3
[
]/[ ] buttons to switch on/off the Dolby  
Headphone listening mode.  
Operating with the Remote Controller  
Tip:  
A table listed later in this manual shows which listening  
mode can be used with which input signal format. See  
page 143.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select a device for  
1
playback.  
Perform this operation when neither the [MODE]  
button nor the [INPUT] button lights. If any but-  
ton lights, press it to turn it off.  
Rolling the scroll wheel lights both buttons, and  
switches the input source and the mode at the  
same time.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening to Radio Broadcasts  
Using the Tuner  
One of the features of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E that  
is most frequently used is its ability to play FM and AM  
broadcast radio stations. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
provides a number of listening modes perfect for listening  
Band  
Frequency  
to the radio and getting the most out of your audio system.  
Also, by presetting radio stations that you listen to  
frequently, you can select them easily by pressing the  
[CH/DISC +/] button on the remote controller.  
When the FM stereo broadcast contains much noise:  
Press the [TUNING MODE] button to switch to the  
manual tuning mode. The AUTOindication disappears  
and the tuner turns into the monaural mode. In the  
monaural mode, the noise will be reduced and the  
broadcast be easier to hear.  
Setting the AM Tuning Interval  
For theAsian orAustralian models, you have to adjust the  
AM Frequency Stepsetting according to your area.  
Use the Setup menu to adjust the AM Frequency Step”  
setting.  
To perform this setting, go to Hardware SetupAM  
Frequency SetupFrequency Step,and select 9 kHz”  
or 10 kHz.For details on this setting, see page 87.  
Tuning into a Radio Station Manually  
(manual tuning)  
Press the [TUNER] input source  
button.  
1
TUNER  
Each time you press the [TUNER] button,  
the input source changes betweenAM and  
FM.  
Tuning into a Radio Station  
Press the [TUNING MODE] button  
to turn off the AUTOindication.  
2
TUNER  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
Turn the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial  
either clockwise or  
3
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CONTROL/TUNING  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
counterclockwise to tune your  
station.  
Turning counterclockwise decreases the  
frequency, and turning clockwise  
increases the frequency.  
TUNING MODE  
SELECT/PRESET  
Tuning into a Radio Station Automatically  
(automatic tuning)  
The tuner frequency changes in 200 kHz (50 kHz)  
increments for FM and 10 kHz (or 9 kHz) increments  
for AM.  
When you tune into an FM station manually, the tuner  
turns into monaural mode. If you want to listen to the FM  
station in stereo, press the [TUNING MODE] button.  
Press the [TUNER] input source  
button.  
Each time you press the [TUNER] but-  
ton, the input source changes between  
AM and FM.  
1
TUNER  
Specifying Radio Stations by Frequency  
Press the [TUNING MODE] button  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
2
3
To select a radio station by  
entering its frequency, press  
the remote controllers  
[DIRECT TUNING] button,  
and then use the number but-  
tons to enter the frequency.  
Remote controller  
to turn on the AUTOindication.  
CLEAR  
#
DIRECT TUNING  
Turn the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial  
either clockwise or  
counterclockwise.This starts  
tuning automatically.  
CONTROL/TUNING  
1
2
3
@.  
-
'/  
ABC  
DEF  
4
5
6
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
The tuner stops automatically where it  
tunes into a station.  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
+
10  
-- ---  
0
/
When you tune into a radio station,  
TUNED  
indicator appears in the  
display. If you tune into an FM station in  
stereo, then FM STEREOappears.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening to Radio Broadcasts—Continued  
Selecting a Preset Radio Station  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
When using the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E:  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
TUNER  
(
BLUE  
Press [TUNER] input source but-  
ton on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
1
2
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
SELECT/PRESET  
Using the [SELECT/PRESET] dial,  
select the number of the desired  
preset station.  
TUNING MODE  
MEMORY  
SELECT/PRESET  
TUNER  
When using the remote controller:  
Presetting a Radio Station  
Press the [INPUT] button,and then  
use the scroll wheel to select  
TUNER.  
Up to 40 stations can be stored in memory as preset radio  
stations.  
1
INPUT  
Tune into the radio station you  
desire (See Tuning Into a Radio  
Station).  
To switch to FM or AM, press the scroll  
wheel.  
1
Press the [MEMORY] button on the  
2
front panel.  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
Flashes  
Use the [CH/DISC +/] button to  
select the presets.  
2
Selecting Presets by Number  
+
To select a preset by number, use the  
remote controllers number buttons. For  
example, to select preset #7, press [7].  
To select preset #12, press [1] then [2].  
CH  
Using the [SELECT/PRESET] dial,  
select a preset number (from 1 to  
40) to assign the station.  
DISC  
3
-
SELECT/PRESET  
The MEMORYindicator blinks for 5  
seconds. Complete the procedure while  
the MEMORYindicator blinks. If the  
MEMORYindicator disappears  
before completing the procedure, go  
back to step 2 and repeat the procedure  
again.  
Erasing a Preset Radio Station  
Press the [TUNER] input source  
1
button and use the [SELECT/PRE-  
SET] dial to select the preset radio  
station that you want to erase (See  
above).  
TUNER  
Press the [MEMORY] button to  
nalize the procedure.  
Lights  
4
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
SELECT/PRESET  
You can enter text names for any of the  
preset radio stations (See page 97).  
Press and hold the [MEMORY] but-  
ton and then press the [TUNING  
MODE] button.  
2
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
The selected preset station is erased.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening to RDS Broadcasts (European models only)  
Listening to RDS Broadcasts  
PTY Program Types in Europe  
RDS reception is available only on the European model  
and only in areas where RDS broadcasts are available.  
The text given in parentheses is what is actually dis-  
played on the TX-NR5000E.  
None (NONE):  
What is RDS?  
RDS stands for Radio Data System and is a type of FM  
broadcasting. RDS was developed within the European  
Broadcasting Union (EBU) and is available in most  
European countries. Many FM broadcasting stations  
now transmit the RDS signals, which provide the addi-  
tional information required. RDS provides you with var-  
ious services so that you can choose a station that  
broadcasts your favorite categories of music, news, or  
other information.  
No program type.  
News reports (NEWS):  
Reports on current events and happenings.  
Current affairs (AFFAIRS):  
Topical reporting of current affairs, often with a wider  
range of topics than news reports.  
Information (INFO):  
General information such as weather forecasts, con-  
sumer affairs, medical help, etc.  
There are three main classications of RDS broadcasts.  
Though they can be tuned into by using the Tuning but-  
tons as normal stations, RDS broadcasts allow you to  
scan for stations of the type and classication for which  
you are looking. This makes it much easier for you to  
nd the station you want (See Performing a PTY Scan”  
and Performing a TP Scanon page 63). The three main  
classications are explained below.  
Sports (SPORT):  
Live sports action, sports news, and interviews.  
Education (EDUCATE):  
Formal educational programs.  
Drama (DRAMA):  
Radio plays and serials.  
Culture (CULTURE):  
RT: Radio Text  
Cultural programs (including religious affairs).  
When an RDS station broadcasting RT information is  
selected, the text information received from the station is  
displayed.  
Science and technology (SCIENCE):  
Programs about the natural sciences and technology.  
Varied (VARIED):  
Speech-based programs not covered by the above cate-  
gories (e.g., quizzes, panel games, and comedy).  
PTY: Program Type  
When an RDS station broadcasting PTY information is  
selected, the station type (classication) is displayed.  
Pop music (POP M):  
Popular commercial music, usually from past or present  
sales charts (e.g., Top 40).  
TP: Traffic Program  
When an RDS station broadcasting TP information is  
selected, trafc information will be broadcast periodi-  
cally.  
Rock music (ROCK M):  
Popular music with an alternative appeal, often not  
appearing on sales charts.  
Notes:  
In some cases, the characters displayed on the display  
of the TX-NR5000E may not be exactly the same as  
the ones broadcast by the radio station. Also, unusual  
characters may appear on the display if the  
TX-NR5000E receives characters that cannot be dis-  
played correctly. This is not a malfunction.  
When an RDS station broadcasting PS information is  
selected, the name of the station is displayed instead  
of the frequency.  
Middle of the road music (M.O.R. M):  
Easy listening music (as opposed to Pop, Rock, or Clas-  
sical).  
Light classics (LIGHT M):  
Classical music for general rather than specialist appre-  
ciation.  
Serious classics (CLASSICS):  
Performances of major orchestral works, symphonies,  
chamber music, etc. (including Grand Opera).  
Other music (OTHER M):  
Music styles not covered by the above categories (e.g.,  
Jazz, Rhythm & Blues, Folk, Country, and Reggae).  
• Alarm (ALARM):  
When an RDS station is making an emergency broad-  
cast, this ALARM will ash on the display.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening to RDS Broadcasts (European models only)—Continued  
Press the [SELECT/PRESET] dial.  
TUNER  
4
The TX-NR5000E will scan until it  
reaches a station of the program type you  
selected. It will then stop briey at that  
station before continuing on until it  
reaches the next station. Pressing the  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial stops the PTY  
scan at that point. If you press the [RT/  
PTY/TP] while NONEis displayed,  
PTY ?will appear. In this case, return  
to step 3.  
SELECT/PRESET  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
POWER  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
OPEN  
ON  
OFF  
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
7
INPUT  
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
L
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
RT/PTY/TP  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
RT/PTY/TP  
SELECT/PRESET  
Press the [SELECT/PRESET] dial  
when it reaches the station that  
you want to listen to.  
Not Foundwill appear when no RDS  
signal is being received from the station.  
Displaying Radio Text (RT)  
5
SELECT/PRESET  
If the station you are currently tuned into is broadcasting  
RT signals, they will be displayed in the front display on  
the TX-NR5000E. If the station does not, this function  
will be ignored.  
RT/PTY/TP  
To display the radio text, press the  
Performing a TP Scan  
[RT/PTY/TP] button once.  
Press the [TUNER] input source  
button.  
1
TUNER  
If the current station you are listening to is not an RDS  
station, only the frequency of the station will appear.  
If Waitingappears on the display, more time is  
required to receive the RT information. When the  
information is received, the characters will scroll  
across the front display.  
Press the [RT/PTY/TP] button  
three times.  
2
If No Text Dataappears on the display, RT informa-  
tion is not available.  
RT/PTY/TP  
The display shows the frequency for 3 seconds and  
returns to program service name.  
[TP]will appear if the current station  
is broadcasting TP signals. This station  
will periodically broadcast trafc infor-  
mation. To nd a different station, pro-  
ceed to the next step. Also, if TPis  
displayed, proceed to the next step.  
Performing a PTY Scan  
Press the [TUNER] input source  
button and select the FM input  
1
TUNER  
source.  
Press the [SELECT/PRESET] dial.  
The TX-NR5000E will scan until it  
reaches a station broadcasting trafc  
information. If Not Foundappears on  
the display, a TP station cannot be  
located.  
3
SELECT/PRESET  
Press the [RT/PTY/TP] button  
twice.  
2
RT/PTY/TP  
The current program type appears on the  
display.  
Using the [SELECT/PRESET] dial,  
select the PTY program type you  
3
SELECT/PRESET  
desire.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Multichannel Playback  
To the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, you can be con-  
How to Set Up  
nected up to two devices, such as a DVD player, that  
deal with multichannel sounds (5.1-7.1 channels).  
To use multichannel connections, you need to specify  
settings on the Input Setup menu. In addition, you can  
set listening modes as you prefer. Enjoy multichannel  
playback in the main room.  
Specify the input source type. At default, DVD is 1,”  
CD is 2,and others are No.”  
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
INPUT  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
10  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
MACRO  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
How to Connect  
Scroll  
wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
INPUT  
Use three or four multichannel connection cables or  
audio connection cables to connect the multichannel  
output jack on the connected device to the MULTI-CH  
IN 1/2 jack on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
M
P
INPUT  
R
R
S
A
D
J
ENTER  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
E
E
X
D
I
U
/ /  
/
R
PREV  
CH  
P
U
U
T
E
SETUP  
S
MULTI  
-
F
AUDIO IN  
L
G
C
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
D
1
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
E
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
ICNH1  
R
R
L
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
1
PH  
4
5
6
7
8
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
GND  
SL  
R
L
Net-Tune”  
trademark of  
1
2
3
is  
a
Onkyo Corporation.  
SBR  
SBL  
MULTI  
-
E
INCH1  
FR  
FL  
FR  
SUB  
SR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
(Net-Tune)  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
SL  
1
SBR  
SBL  
C
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
MULTI  
G
S
VIDEO  
H
-
ICNH2  
A
B
C
D
F
SURR  
R
SURR BACK  
R
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
B
L
SL  
R
Press the [INPUT] button, and then roll the  
scroll wheel to select the input source to  
be set.  
CENTER SUB  
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
1
OUT  
B
SBR  
SBL  
Press the scroll wheel, and then press the  
[SETUP] button to display the Main menu.  
2
3
FRONT  
Press the [ ]/[ ] buttons to selectInput  
Setup,and then press the [ENTER] but-  
ton.  
R
L
SUB  
CENTER  
SURR  
R
L
Press the [ /[ ] buttons to selectAudio  
Assign,and then press the [ENTER] but-  
ton.  
4
5
SURR  
BACK  
Press the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
Multichannel,and then select a setting  
with the [ ]/[ ] buttons.  
Select 1when connected to MULTI-CH  
IN 1, or 2when connected to MULTI-CH  
IN 2.  
Press the [SETUP] button.  
Setting is completed, and the menu screen disap-  
pears.  
6
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Multichannel Playback—Continued  
To congure the listening mode settings including  
audio effect and playback options:  
Playing Back in Multichannel Sound  
TV CH  
You can specify detailed settings for the decode mode  
and the speaker environment for multichannel playback  
(Listening Mode Setup). See page 102 for details.  
-
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
INPUT  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
MACRO  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Adjusting the Volume Level of  
Speakers for Multichannel Playback  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
INPUT  
VOL /  
+
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
TV  
INPUT  
-
+
PREV  
CH  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
LEVEL /+  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
-
+
TEST  
T
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
CH SEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
AUDIO SEL  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
Press the scroll wheel, and then press the  
[CH SEL] button to select a speaker  
whose volume level you want to adjust.  
Speakers set by the Speaker Conguration sub-  
menu on the Speaker/Output Setup menu are dis-  
played on a one-by-one basis.  
1
Press the [INPUT] button, and then roll the  
scroll wheel to select the input source to  
be set.  
1
2
Press the scroll wheel, and then press  
(repeatedly) the [AUDIO SEL] button to  
select Multich.”  
Press the [LEVEL /+] button to adjust the  
volume level.  
2
You can adjust in the range from 12 dB to +12  
dB. The subwoofer can be adjusted in the range  
from 15 dB to +12 dB.  
Start playing.  
3
4
Adjust the volume level with the [VOL  
buttons.  
You can adjust the volume level in the range from  
, 81.5 dB to 18.0 dB (when Relative is set for  
Volume Setup).  
]
Hint:  
The volume level of each speaker for multichannel  
sounds is different from the calibration level to be set  
with the test sound described on page 90. Adjustment  
made here is not reected in playing other than the mul-  
tichannel playback.  
Hint:  
You can also adjust the volume level with the  
input source button, the [AUDIO SELECTOR]  
button, and the [MASTER VOLUME] dial on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
You can also set the listening mode in advance for mul-  
tichannel playback (Listening Mode Preset). To do so,  
select Input SetupListening Mode Preset→  
Multichannelon the Setup menu to choose the pre-  
ferred mode. This defaults to Multichannel.”  
See page 57 for details of the listening mode, and page  
97 for the listening mode preset.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Movies and Music in the Remote Zone  
(Zone 2/3)  
You can connect speakers and ampliers for the remote  
zone, and enjoy different sources in a remote zone  
(Zone 2 or Zone 3).  
When Connecting the Pre-main Amplifier or  
Receiver (Zone 2 or Zone 3)  
You can enjoy a different source in a remote zone while  
a 7.1 channel source is being played in the main room.  
Adjust the volume level on the pre-main amplier or  
receiver in the remote zone.  
There are three ways to enjoy in a remote zone:  
Connecting and Setup  
When Connecting Only Speakers (Zone 2)  
Main Room  
You can enjoy a different source in a remote zone  
while a 5.1 channel source is being played in the  
main room.  
TV  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Adjust the volume level on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Main Room  
TV  
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E  
Zone 2/Zone 3  
TV  
IN  
R
L
Receiver/  
Pre-main amplier  
(
)
(
)
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR BACK  
R
ASSIGNABLE  
SURR BACK  
L
Connect the pre-main amplier or  
receiver for Zone 2 or Zone 3 to the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
1
SPEAKERS  
B
SPEAKERS  
B
Connect to any of the following terminals:  
AUDIO OUT 1-5  
Default:  
Analog 4 (AUDIO OUT 4): Zone 2 Out  
Analog 5 (AUDIO OUT 5): Zone 3 Out  
DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2  
DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2  
Zone 2  
Connect the speakers for Zone 2 to SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
1
2
Connect the speakers for Zone 2 or Zone  
3 to the pre-main amplier or receiver.  
2
3
Connect the video component for Zone 2  
to any of the composite VIDEO OUT 1-4  
terminals.  
Connect the video component for Zone 2  
or Zone 3 to any of the composite VIDEO  
OUT 1-4 terminals.  
Set the Setup menu.  
3
Set the Setup menu.  
1. On the Setup menu (See page 88), select  
Speaker/Output SetupSpeaker Con-  
guration,and set Speaker B Surr Bkto  
Powered Zone 2.”  
2. Similarly, select Speaker/Output Setup→  
Video Output Assign,and set the terminal  
connected to the component to Zone 2  
Out.”  
4
1. On the Setup menu (See page 91), select  
Speaker/Output SetupAudio Output  
Assign,and set the terminal to which the  
component is connected to Zone 2 Outor  
Zone 3 Out.”  
2. Then, set Zone 2 Outor Zone 3 Outin  
the Audio Output Assign sub-menu to  
Line Out (xed).”  
3. Similarly, select Speaker/Output Setup→  
Video Output Assign,and set the terminal  
to which the component is connected to  
Zone 2 Outor Zone 3 Out.”  
3. Press the [SETUP] button to close the  
menu.  
4. Press the [SETUP] button to close the menu.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Movies and Music in the Remote Zone (Zone 2/3)—Continued  
When Connecting the Power Amplifier (Zone 2  
Enjoying Movies and Music in a  
or Zone 3)  
Remote Zone  
You can enjoy a different source in a remote zone  
while a 7.1 channel source is being played in the  
main room.  
Adjust the volume level on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E (not on the power amplier).  
The sleep timer in the main room also works in Zone  
2 and Zone 3. To make the sleep timer effective only  
in Zone 2 or Zone 3, set the sleep timer on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E in the main room, and  
then put it into the standby status.  
When Speaker B Surr Backis set to Powered  
Main Room  
Zone 2on the Speaker Conguration sub-menu of  
TV  
the Speaker/Output Setup menu, 7.1 channel play-  
back is disabled in the main room.  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Sounds and pictures that can be output to Zone 2 and  
Zone 3 are as follows:  
REC/  
From Input  
Terminal  
ZONE  
2
ZONE To Output Terminal  
3
*1  
AUDIO OUT 1-5  
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
i.LINK  
(AUDIO)  
*2  
*2  
*2  
DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2  
DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2  
AUDIO OUT 1-5  
Zone 2/Zone 3  
*2  
TV  
Power amp  
IN  
ETHERNET,  
PH,  
AUDIO IN 1-9  
R
L
DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2  
DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2  
AUDIO OUT 1-5  
*3  
*1  
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL 1-6,  
DIGITAL IN  
Connect the power amplier for Zone 2 or  
Zone 3 to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Connect to any of the following terminals:  
AUDIO OUT 1-5  
DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2  
DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2  
1
DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2  
DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2  
VIDEO OUT 1-4  
COAXIAL 1-6  
VIDEO IN 1-6,  
S VIDEO IN 1-  
6, COMPO-  
NENT VIDEO  
IN 1-6  
S VIDEO OUT 1-4  
Connect the speakers for Zone 2 or Zone  
3 to the power amplier.  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
2
3
*1 Only PCM output  
Connect the video component for Zone 2  
or Zone 3 to any of the composite VIDEO  
OUT 1-4 terminals.  
*2 Super Audio CD and DVD-Audio are not output.  
*3 Possible for 2 channel downmix signal.  
Columns covered by \ indicate that no setting related  
to the column is specied for Zone 2 Out or Zone 3 Out  
in Audio Output Assignor Video Output Assign.”  
Set the Setup menu.  
4
1. On the Setup menu (See page 91), select  
Speaker/Output SetupAudio Output  
Assign,and set the terminal to which the  
component is connected to Zone 2 Outor  
Zone 3 Out.”  
2. Then, set Zone 2 Outor Zone 3 Outin  
the Audio Output Assign sub-menu to Pre  
Out (variable).”  
3. Similarly, select Speaker/Output Setup→  
Video Output Assign,and set the terminal  
to which the component is connected to  
Zone 2 Outor Zone 3 Out.”  
4. Press the [SETUP] button to close the  
menu.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Movies and Music in the Remote Zone (Zone 2/3)—Continued  
Operating with the Remote Controller  
Operating on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
When operating with the remote controller, how to  
operate depends on the location of Zone 2 or Zone 3, or  
the distance from the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Point the remote controller at the infrared receiver on  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, and then operate the  
controller.  
STANDBY/ON  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
Install a remote controller sensor in Zone 2 or Zone 3  
through an IR connection (See page 45).  
Switch the Transmission Signal Format to RF (Radio  
Frequency) (depending on the destination) (See page  
141).  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
ZONE2  
REC/ZONE3  
SELECT/PRESET CONTROL / TUNING  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
ON, STANDBY  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
Turn on the power supply to the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, and then select  
a source for Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
For Zone 2, press the [ZONE 2] button, and then  
select the source with the [SELECT/PRESET] dial.  
For Zone 3, press the [REC/ZONE 3] button, and  
then, select the source with the [CONTROL/  
TUNING] dial.  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
1
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
/
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
ZONE 3  
ZONE 2  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
CH DISC +/–  
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
When you press the [ZONE 2] or [REC/ZONE 3]  
button, the [STANDBY] indicator on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E blinks for ve sec-  
onds, so perform operations while it is blinking.  
The source button for Zone 2 lights in green and  
the source buttton for Zone 3 lights in red.  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
REPEAT  
A-B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
LEVEL /+  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Re-EQ  
L
NIGHT  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
-
RC 558M  
Power on the devices in Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
Press the [ZONE 2] or [ZONE 3] button, and  
then the [ON] button.  
To switch the source for Zone 2 (or Zone 3) and  
the main room simultaneously:  
Repeatedly press the [ZONE 2] (or [REC/ZONE  
3]) button to display Z2Sel:SOURCE,and then  
select the source.  
1
2
Select a source.  
Rotate the scroll wheel to select a source while  
the [ZONE 2] or [ZONE 3] button is lighted (if  
the button is not lighted, press the [ZONE2] or  
[ZONE 3] button to light it).  
When you have selected the tuner, you can  
choose a preset channel with the [CH DISC  
+/] button.  
Adjust the volume level.  
2
For Zone 2, press the [LEVEL] button under the  
[ZONE 2] button, and then adjust with the  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial.  
For Zone 3, press the [LEVEL] button under the  
[REC/ZONE 3] button, and then adjust with the  
[CONTROL/TUNING] dial.  
Adjust the volume level.  
Notes:  
3
Press the [ZONE 2] (or [ZONE 3]) button, and  
within 5 seconds, press the [LEVEL /+] button  
to adjust the volume level.  
When a pre-main amplier or receiver is  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
the volume level should be adjusted at the  
connected component side.  
Notes:  
When the pre-main amplier or receiver is  
connected, the volume level should be adjusted  
at the connected component side.  
When not using Zone 2 or Zone 3, press the  
[ZONE 2] (or [ZONE 3]) button, and then  
press the [STANDBY] button.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Movies and Music in the  
Remote Zone (Zone 2/3)—  
Continued  
Recording a Source  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E can not only record the  
playing source but can also record a source while play-  
ing another source. You can also combine a video and  
audio to create a new source.  
Signals that can be output to a video/audio recording  
device vary with the type of jack connected. Check the  
following conditions before starting recording:  
When not using Zone 2 or Zone 3, press the  
[ZONE 2] (or [REC/ZONE 3]) button, and  
then press the [STANDBY/ON] button. Or  
press the [ZONE 2] (or [REC/ZONE 3]) but-  
ton, and then turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial  
to select Off.In the case of Zone 2, the green  
indicator on the input source button is turned  
off, and in the case of Zone 3, the red indicator  
is turned off.  
When operating in the main room, be sure to  
conrm that the [STANDBY] indicator is not  
blinking, and then start operations. When not  
using in the main room, press the [STANDBY/  
ON] button. If the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
is in the standby status, the power supply to  
Zone 2 and Zone 3 is not switched off.  
Audio  
Signals (analog) from the ETHERNET, PH, or  
AUDIO IN jacks are output only to the AUDIO OUT  
jacks. Music signals of MP3, WMA, and WAVE to be  
played with Net-Audio are also output only to analog  
audio output jacks.  
No signal is output from the MULTI-CH IN jacks.  
No signal is output from the HDMI IN jacks. Record-  
ing via the HDMI OUT jack is also disabled because  
Rec Out is not available in Audio Output Assign.  
Signals from the DIGITAL IN OPTICAL or COAX-  
IAL jacks are output to the DIGITAL OUT OPTI-  
CAL or COAXIAL jacks. PCM signals are converted  
into analog signals, and also output to the AUDIO  
OUT jacks.  
Only PCM signals are output from the i.LINK  
(AUDIO) terminals to theAUDIO OUT jacks. Digital  
signals are output from the i.LINK (AUDIO) termi-  
nals to the DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL or COAXIAL  
jacks, but signals on Super Audio CD and DVD-  
Audio are not output.  
Video  
Video signals from the VIDEO IN, S VIDEO IN, or  
COMPONENT VIDEO IN jack are output only to the  
VIDEO OUT jacks.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording a Source—Continued  
Some steps can also be operated on the remote control-  
ler, but described here are operations on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Press the input source button to select  
the component for audio/video recording  
(player side).  
4
5
Notes:  
No surround effects can be recorded.  
No DVD or any sources whose copyright is protected  
can be recorded.  
There are some restrictions on recording of digital  
audio/video signals. Refer to the manual of your  
recording component.  
If recorded as analog signals, DTS signals are  
recorded as noise, so never record signals from a  
DTS-compatible CD or LD.  
Press the [REC/ZONE 3] button, and within 3  
seconds, selectRec Sel:SOURCEwith the  
[CONTROL/TUNING] dial.  
Pressing the [REC/ZONE 3] button makes the  
[STANDBY] indicator blink for 3 seconds.  
Select the target source while the indicator is  
blinking. The name of the source to be recorded  
is indicated in the display window, and the button  
for the source selected lights in red.  
Input source buttons  
Audio/video recording is enabled on the compo-  
nent for which Rec Outwas specied in step 3.  
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
Prepare the component for audio/video  
recording (recorder side).  
Put the component for audio/video recording  
into the recording standby status.  
You should adjust the recording level on the  
recording component.  
For how to record, refer to the manual of the  
recoding component.  
STANDBY  
6
7
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
SETUP  
CONTROL/TUNING  
SELECT/PRESET  
REC/ZONE 3  
STANDBY indicator  
Start audio/video recording  
Recording Audio/Video While Playing  
Play the component selected in step 4.  
Switching the source during audio/video  
recording will record the source newly  
selected.  
If you select FM (or AM) with the [TUNER]  
input source button when the recording source  
is set to AM (or FM), the output for the record-  
ing source also changes to AM (or FM).  
Recording music or a movie you are currently playing.  
Operate on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E in the main  
room.  
Turn on the power supply to TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
1
Check the connection to your recording  
component.  
2
An audio recorder should be connected to the  
AUDIO OUT or DIGITAL OUT jacks, and a  
video recorder to the VIDEO OUT jacks.  
Recording Audio/Video on a  
Component While Playing Another  
You can record an audio source or a video on a compo-  
nent while playing another source on another compo-  
nent. For example, you can record a CD while watching  
a DVD. Operate this function on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E in the main room.  
Check settings for a recorder connected.  
3
1. On the Setup menu (See page 91), select  
Speaker/Output SetupAudio Output  
Assign,and specify Rec Outas the setting  
for the jack to which your audio recording  
component is connected.  
2. Similarly, select Speaker/Output Setup→  
Video Output Assign,and specify Video  
XX Rec Outas the setting for the jack to  
which your video recording component is  
connected.  
Turn on the power supply to TX-NR1000/  
1
TX-NR5000E in MAIN A or MAIN B mode.  
Proceeding to the next step in the Standby status  
makes the Zone 3 mode effective, so be sure to  
turn on the power source.  
3. Press the [SETUP] button to close the menu.  
Check connections and settings to the  
recording component.  
Refer to steps 2 and 3 in Recording Audio/  
Video While Playingin the previous section.  
2
Hint:  
Since Zone 3 Out and Rec Out use the same cir-  
cuitry, audio recording is disabled if Zone 3 Out  
is specied. Audio/video recording is also dis-  
abled on the same component as that for playing.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording a Source—Continued  
Press the [REC/ZONE3] button,and within  
3 seconds, selectRec Sel:SOURCEwith  
the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial.  
Pressing the [REC/ZONE 3] button makes the  
[STANDBY] indicator blink for 3 seconds.  
Select the target sources while the indicator is  
blinking. The name of the source to be recorded  
is indicated in the display window. Audio/video  
recording is enabled on the component for which  
Rec Outwas specied in step 2.  
Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to select  
Composite Video,and set it to 3with  
the [CONTROL/TUNING] dial.  
3
6
7
After setting to 3,press the [SETUP] button.  
Insert a CD in the CD player and insert a  
tape in the video camera connected to the  
VIDEO IN 3 jacks.  
Insert a tape in the VCR connected to the  
VIDEO OUT 2 jacks.  
8
9
Prepare the component for audio/video  
recording (recorder side).  
4
Press the [REC/ZONE 3] button, and  
within 8 seconds, select Rec  
Sel:SOURCEwith the [CONTROL/TUN-  
ING] dial.  
Now, the CD player has been selected as the audio  
input source, and VIDEO 3 as the video input  
source.  
Start audio/video recording.  
You cannot listen to a broadcast from one station  
while recording a broadcast from another station.  
5
Start recording on theVCR, and start play-  
ing on the CD player and the video cam-  
era.  
Recording theVideo from One Source  
and the Audio from Another Source  
10  
You can add audio signals from a source to a video of  
another source to make your own custom video record-  
ings. Below is an example of recording audio signals  
from a CD player connected to the DIGITAL IN OPTI-  
CAL 2 jack and the video from a video camera con-  
nected to VIDEO IN 3 onto a video cassette tape on a  
VCR connected to VIDEO OUT 2.  
Playback starts on the component selected in  
steps 3-6.  
Note:  
Switching the source during audio/video record-  
ing will record the source newly selected.  
Operate this function in the main room.  
Turn on the power supply to the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E in MAIN A or  
MAIN B mode.  
1
Check connections and settings to the  
recording component.  
2
Refer to steps 2 and 3 in RecordingAudio/Video  
While Playingon page 70.  
Press the [CD] input source button.  
3
Press the [SETUP] button to display Main  
menu, and turn the [SELECT/PRESET]  
dial to select Input Setup.”  
4
After selecting Input Setup,press the [ENTER]  
button.  
To carry out steps 3-6 on the remote controller, fol-  
low the procedures described on page 95.  
Turn the [SELECT/PRESET] dial to select  
Video Setup,and press the [ENTER]  
5
button.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio  
Computer Requirements  
About Net-Tune  
The computer requirements necessary for running the  
Net-Tune Central server software are as follows:  
Operating system: Windows XP or 2000 (Mac OS  
not supported).  
Processor: Intel Pentium III, 600 MHz or higher  
Memory: 128 MB (Windows 2000) 256 MB (Win-  
dows XP)  
Display: 800 x 600 pixels or higher, High Color  
• LAN/Ethernet network port  
• Sound capabilities  
Hard disk: At least 20 MB for Net-Tune Central.  
Obviously youll also need space to store your music  
les. MP3 and WMA uses approximately 1 MB per  
minute, while WAV uses approximately 10 MB per  
minute, although this will depend on the sampling rate  
and bit rate that you use. MP3 les made using certain  
encoders may not be playable, or may be noisy when  
played.  
A Net-Tune server is a computer server running Net-  
Tune system protocol, including a Net-Tune-compatible  
home server or a PC with Net-Tune Central installed.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E can be used as a Net-  
Tune client on a standard Ethernet network. By install-  
ing Onkyos Net-Tune Central server software on your  
computer, you can play all of your MP3, WMA, and  
WAV les through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. If  
your network is connected to the Internet, you can also  
tune into Internet radio stations.  
Internet Radio  
With Internet radio you can:  
Listen to stations that use MP3 or WMA format  
streaming.  
Select stations by genre, location, or language.  
Preset up to 30 Internet radio stations.  
Net-Tune  
Network Requirements  
For audio delivery over Ethernet, Onkyo developed  
NTSP (Net-Tune System Protocol). Since its based on  
the industry standard TCP/IP protocol, its efcient and  
very responsive.  
You can download Onkyos Net-Tune Central server  
software from the following Onkyo Web sites:  
America: http://www.onkyousa.com/net-tune/  
Europe: http://www.onkyo.net/net-tune/  
Japan: http://www.onkyo.com.jp/  
I Ethernet Network  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es Ethernet port sup-  
ports 10Base-T. For best results, a 100Base-T switched  
Ethernet network is recommended. Although its theo-  
retically possible to use a wireless network, due to  
unpredictable performance, it may not provide satisfac-  
tory results, so a wired network is recommended.  
I Ethernet Router  
A router manages the network, routing data and supply-  
ing IP addresses. Your router must support the follow-  
ing:  
NAT (Network Address Translation)  
NAT allows several networked computers to access  
the Internet simultaneously via a single Internet con-  
nection. The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E needs Inter-  
net access for Internet radio.  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Conguration Protocol)  
DHCP supplies IP address information to network  
devices, allowing them to congure themselves auto-  
matically.  
A router with a 100Base-TX switch built-in is recom-  
mended.  
Asia, Oceania, and Latin America:  
http://www.onkyo-intl.com/  
Net-Tune Central searches your PCs hard disk for  
music les and automatically creates a music database,  
making it very easy to set up. Net-Tune clients, includ-  
ing the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, can then play music  
in the database.  
Net-Tune Central supports the following le formats,  
and sampling rates of 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, and 48 kHz.  
WAV: high quality, uncompressed, linear PCM.  
MP3: high quality, compressed, small le size.  
WMA: high quality, compressed, smaller le size  
than MP3, developed by Microsoft (Protected WMA  
les cannot be played).  
Before you download Net-Tune Central, youll be  
prompted to enter the serial number printed on the rear  
of your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. Depending on your  
Internet connection, it may take 10 or more minutes to  
download.  
Some routers have a modem built-in, and some ISPs  
require you to use specic routers. Please consult your  
ISP or computer dealer if youre unsure.  
I CAT5 Ethernet cable  
Use a standard CAT5 Ethernet cable (straight type).  
I Internet Access (for Internet radio)  
Net-Tune Central Editing Functions  
To use Internet radio, your Ethernet network must have  
Internet access. A narrowband Internet connection (e.g.,  
56K modem, ISDN) will not provide satisfactory  
results, so a broadband connection is strongly recom-  
mended (e.g., cable modem, xDSL modem, etc.). Please  
consult your ISP or computer dealer if youre unsure.  
With Net-Tune Central you can edit the titles, album,  
and artist names of your MP3, WMA, and WAV les,  
and create and edit genre names. In addition, you can  
make playlists of your favorite tracks.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Notes:  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E does not support  
PPPoE settings, so if you have a PPPoE-type Internet  
connection, you must use a PPPoE compatible router.  
Depending on your ISP, you may need to specify a  
proxy server to use Internet radio. If your PC is con-  
gured to use a proxy server, use the same settings  
(See page 121).  
To use Internet radio with the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, your broadband Internet connection  
needs to be up and running and able to access the  
Web. Please consult your ISP if you have any prob-  
lems with your Internet connection.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E uses DHCP andAutoIP  
to congure its network settings automatically. If you  
want to congure these settings manually, see page 121.  
NetworkingYour TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
To connect the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to your Ethernet network, plug one end of a CAT5 Ethernet cable into the  
ETHERNET (Net-Tune) port, and plug the other end into a LAN port on your router or switch.  
The following diagram shows how you can connect the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to your Ethernet network. Here it  
is connected to a LAN port on the router, which has a 4-port 100Base-TX switch built-in.  
You can connect any number of TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es to the network, and Net-Tune Central can serve up to three  
clients simultaneously, so you can enjoy Net-Tune in three separate rooms simultaneously. The following diagram  
shows a Net-Tune network with two TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es.  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
MULTI  
F
AUDIO IN  
L
G
COMPONENT  
J
K
L
C
DIGITAL IN  
OPTICAL  
D
DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL  
E
H
S
VIDEO  
IN  
VIDEO  
IN  
I
-
C
H
VIDEO  
I
N
1
R
R
L
IN  
1
FR  
SUB  
SR  
I
N
2
FL  
RS232  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
IN  
ANTENNA  
HDMI  
4
1
1
PH  
4
5
6
7
8
1
Y
Y
IN  
1
C
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
PB  
GND  
PB  
SL  
R
L
REMOTE  
HDMI, the HDMI logo  
Net-Tune”  
trademark of  
12V  
CONTROL  
1
2
3
PR  
is  
a
trademark  
is  
a
TRIGGER  
OUT  
FM  
75  
or registered  
Onkyo Corporation.  
trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
SBR  
SBL  
OUT  
1
I
N
3
A
P
R
200mA MAX.  
IN  
2
Y
B
D
100mA MAX.  
C
100mA MAX.  
OUT  
2
FR  
FL  
ETHERNET  
(Net-Tune)  
P
B
R
100mA MAX.  
Y
E
AM  
100mA MAX.  
SUB  
SR  
C
1
2
9
4
P
PB  
MAIN  
SL  
Internet radio  
1
3
4
PC  
ZONE  
2
3
SBR  
SBL  
P
R
3
5
2
R
L
R
L
OUT  
OUT  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
L
ZONE  
IR  
MULTI  
G
S
VIDEO  
H
S
VIDEO  
-
C
H
IN  
OUT  
I
N
2
A
B
C
F
I
J
K
SURR  
R
SURR BAK  
R
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
SURR BACK  
SINGLE  
L
(
ASSIGNABLE  
)
SURR  
L
PRE OUT  
SURR  
A
(
)
FRONT  
SURR  
BACK  
A
B
SPEAKERS  
SPEAKERS  
A
B
L
AC INLET  
AC OUTLET  
AC 120V 60Hz  
SWITCHED  
120W 1A MAX.  
R
C
E
N
T
E
R
S
U
B
SUB  
FRONT  
R
(BTL)  
FRONT  
L
(BTL)  
WOOFER WOOFER  
PRE  
UDC/UDT  
MODEL NO. TX-NR1000  
OUT  
B
ETHERNET  
(
)
Net-Tune  
Internet radio  
Modem  
To the WAN side  
Modem  
Router  
To the LAN side port  
To the LAN side port  
To the WAN side  
Router  
To the LAN  
side port  
To the LAN side port  
Room 2  
Room 1  
To the LAN  
side port  
PC  
LAN port/  
Ethernet, etc.  
You can install Net-Tune central on several networked computers and use the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es Select  
Server setting to select the server whose music database you want to access (See page 95).  
About Network Conguration  
When you use a broadband router with the DHCP function enabled, the network settings will be congured automati-  
cally. In this case, you do not have to make any settings using the setup menu. If you disabled the DHCP function on  
the broadband router, congure the network settings manually referring to page 121.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Scroll wheel  
Using the Remote Controller  
To select Net-Tune mode, press the [MODE] button,  
and then roll the scroll wheel until “NET-T” appears  
on the display.  
Note:  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
TV  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor [MODE] button  
is illuminated, the scroll wheel changes the input source  
and remote controller mode simultaneously (when you  
enter the Net-Tune mode, be sure that the LCD display  
shows MSRVor IRDin the top line and NET-Tin  
the bottom line).  
I
INPUT  
+
TV CH  
-
2
3
@.  
-
'/  
ABC  
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
6
JKL  
MNO  
7
8
9
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
10  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
REPEAT  
PURE A  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
1Number/letter buttons  
FRANDOM button  
These buttons are used to enter numbers and letters  
when searching for music in your Net-Tune server.  
This button is used for random playback.  
GARTIST button  
2MODE button  
This button is used to search the Net-Tune servers  
music library by artist.  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
the remote controller modes. Press this button rst,  
and then roll the scroll wheel until NET-Tappears  
on the display.  
HGENRE button  
This button is used to search the Net-Tune servers  
music library by genre, and to search for Internet  
radio stations by genre.  
3Up/Down/Left/Right  
/
/
/
& ENTER  
buttons  
ILOCATION button  
These buttons are used to navigate Internet radio  
and Net-Tune server menus. The [ENTER] button is  
used to conrm items and to start playback of the  
Net-Tune server.  
This button is used to search for Internet radio sta-  
tions by country.  
JLANGUAGE button  
This button is used to search for Internet radio sta-  
tions by language.  
4CH/DISC +/button  
This button is used to select Internet radio presets.  
5Play  
button  
This button is used to start playback of the Net-Tune  
server.  
6Previous/Next  
/
buttons  
The Previous  
button is used to select the pre-  
vious track. During playback it selects the begin-  
ning of the current track. The Next  
used to select the next track.  
button is  
7Pause  
button  
This button is used to pause playback.  
8REPEAT button  
This button is used for repeat playback.  
9ALBUM button  
This button is used to search the Net-Tune servers  
music library by album.  
0PLAYLIST button  
This button is used to search the Net-Tune servers  
library by playlist.  
ACAPS button  
This button is used to select lowercase letters,  
uppercase letters, and numbers when searching for  
the Net-Tune servers music by album, artist, or  
playlist.  
BDELETE button  
This button is used to delete characters entered with  
the number/letter buttons.  
CINPUT button  
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
MSRV(Music Server) or IRD(Internet Radio)  
appears on the display.  
DFR/FF  
The FR  
FF  
/
buttons  
button is used to start fast reverse. The  
button is used to start fast forward.  
EStop  
button  
This button is used to stop playback.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
NET AUDIO  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
Wait while your requested data is down-  
load from the XiVA Internet Radio Ser-  
vice.  
4
MASTER VOLUME  
STANDBY/ON  
STANDBY  
DISPLAY  
DVD  
TAPE  
1
TAPE  
2
TUNER  
PHONO  
C
D
NET AUDIO  
ENTER  
REC  
/
ZONE  
MAIN  
ZONE GREEN  
3
(
RED  
)
)
)
(
BLUE  
2
(
VIDEO  
1
VIDEO  
2
VIDEO  
3
VIDEO  
4
VIDEO  
5
VIDEO  
6
VIDEO  
7
OPEN  
PURE AUDIO  
* What is the XiVA Internet Radio  
Service?  
LISTENING  
MODE  
AUDIO  
SELECTOR  
TONE  
ZONE  
2
SELECT/PRESET  
SETUP  
EXIT  
CONTROL/TUNING  
REC/ZONE  
LEVEL  
3
VIDE  
O
7
INPUT  
L
DIGITAL  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PHONES  
TUNING  
MODE  
MEMORY  
DIMMER  
LEVEL  
The XiVA Internet Radio Service pro-  
vides tuning information, allowing  
you to select from a large number of  
stations. You can nd Internet Radio  
Stations based on your interests,  
musical taste, language, and location.  
CLEAR  
PUSH TO ENTER  
PUSH TO ENTER  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
4
5
6
When Genre is selected:  
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
0
Allow a few moments until the Genre  
menu appears. When the main list of  
genres appears, use the [ ]/[ ] buttons  
to select the genre desired. Pressing the  
[ENTER] button brings up the sub-list  
of the genre you selected, which  
#
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
INPUT  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
CH/DISC +/–  
ENTER,  
-
PREV  
CH  
/ /  
/
DISPLAY  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
prompts you to further select one of the  
items using the [ ]/[ ] buttons.  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
REPEAT  
A-B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
TEST  
T
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
When Location is selected:  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Re-EQ  
L
NIGHT  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
The list containing names of countries  
appears. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to  
select the desired item.  
-
RC 558M  
Enjoying Internet Radio  
When Language is selected:  
The list of languages appears. Use the  
To listen to Internet radio, the connection/conguration  
[
]/[ ] buttons to select your desired  
requirements listed on pages 72-73 must be satised.  
item.  
While neither the [INPUT] button  
1
If no list is found, No Listappears.  
You can return from this screen to the  
previous selection screen by pressing the  
nor [MODE] button is illuminated,  
roll the scroll wheel to select  
IRD (Internet Radio).  
[
] button.  
NET-Tappears in the bottom line.  
On the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
press the [NET AUDIO] button. This  
button switches between two alternative  
settings: Server and Internet Radio.  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
You are presented with a list of radio sta-  
tion names.  
5
6
ENTER  
Press the [DISPLAY] button on the  
remote controller.  
If the main menu has been already dis-  
played, go to the next step.  
2
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
one of the radio stations.  
You can return to the previous step by  
pressing the [ ] button.  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
one of the main menus: Genre,  
Location, or Language.  
3
ENTER  
To cancel, press the [ ] button.  
ENTER  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Choosing a Preset Internet Radio Station  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
Buffering starts with the following mes-  
sage displayed.  
7
While neither the [INPUT] button  
1
nor [MODE] button is illuminated,  
roll the scroll wheel to select IRD  
(Internet Radio).  
ENTER  
When the buffering is complete, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E starts play-  
back of the broadcast.  
Use the remote controllers  
[CH DISC +/] button to select the  
2
Note:  
preset.  
+
If youre using a narrowband Internet  
connection (e.g., 56K modem, ISDN),  
depending on the station, Internet radio  
may not work satisfactorily. For best  
results use a broadband connection (e.g.,  
cable modem, xDSL modem, etc).  
You can switch the displayed content  
using the [ ]/[ ] buttons.  
When you choose a preset station, the  
station name is displayed for 5 seconds,  
and then the progress of buffering is dis-  
played instead.  
CH  
DISC  
-
After the switch operation, the display  
mode appears for 3 seconds, and then  
the appropriate information scrolls.  
If there is no information on title or art-  
ist, No Infoappears.  
When using the OSD screen, all the  
information is displayed on one screen  
without scrolling.  
When the progress of buffering reaches  
100%, you will be presented with the  
playing screen.  
Erasing a preset Internet radio station  
OSD iNet Radio Station ONK  
7ch  
Select the station to erase, follow-  
ing the instructions described  
above.  
1
Title:  
Station ONK Live  
Program:  
Station ONK Live  
Artist:  
RealOnkyoNet.com  
Data:  
Press the [ ] button.  
WMA 20kbps  
2
Tuned  
ch  
Display  
ENTER  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E enters  
into preset erase mode.  
Presetting Internet Radio Stations  
You can preset up to 30 Internet radio stations.  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
Your selected station is erased.  
3
Receive your desired station.  
1
ENTER  
Press the [ ] button.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E enters  
into preset mode; the currently selected  
2
preset number blinks for 5 seconds.  
ENTER  
Preset number  
ch  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
The preset is now complete.  
3
ENTER  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
“Disconnected”  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
The Net-Tune server may not start or the  
server connected to previously may not  
be found. Conrm the connections  
between router, the Net-Tune server, and  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. Start the  
Net-Tune server or select another server  
referring to Select Serveron Music  
Server Sub-menu(See page 95).  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
Number/letter  
buttons  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
/
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
INPUT  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
ENTER,  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
/ /  
/
-
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
,
,
,
,
,
,
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
Press the [ ] button to play the  
music le.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E provides  
ve normal display modes; you can use  
the [ ]/[ ] button to switch among  
them.  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
4
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
REPEAT  
ALBUM  
PLAYLIST  
RANDOM  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
REPEAT  
A-B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
TEST  
T
ONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
Remote  
controller  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Re-EQ  
L
NIGHT  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
-
RC 558M  
Playing a Music File Saved on the  
Net-Tune Server  
OSD  
Music Server  
Track: 1/12  
Play  
1m20s>  
My sweet candy  
To play music les saved on your PC, the requirements  
listed on page 72 must be satised.  
Album:  
My Best 100  
Artist:  
Happy PanPot  
Data:  
Turn on the Net-Tune server.  
Wait until the Net-Tune server starts up.  
It may take a few second.  
MP3 160kbps  
1
Display  
Turn on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
When you connect the TX-NR1000/  
2
To stop playback:  
Press the [ ] button on the remote controller.  
To pause playback:  
Press the [ ] button on the remote controller.  
To select a track:  
TX-NR5000E to the network the rst time,  
it will be connected to the rst server found.  
While neither the [INPUT] button  
3
Press the [  
ler.  
]/[  
] button on the remote control-  
nor [MODE] button is illuminated,  
roll the scroll wheel to select  
MSRV (Music Server).  
NET-Tappears in the bottom line.  
On the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, press  
the [NET AUDIO] button. This button  
switches between two alternative settings:  
Server and Internet Radio.  
Until the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
connects to the network, nds the server,  
and completes the connection, Network  
Starting...and Connecting...appears.  
After completing the connection to the  
Net-Tune server, the display changes to  
the normal indication.  
If the following messages appear, check  
the message meaning and perform the  
appropriate procedures.  
Press the [  
Press the [  
] button to move to the next track.  
] button to move to the beginning of  
the current track; hold down the [  
move to the previous track.  
] button to  
You can also use the number/letter buttons to select a  
track.  
Examples:  
To select number 3, press 3.  
To select number 10, press --/---, 1 and 0.  
To select number 37, press --/---, 3 and 7.  
To select number 123, press --/--- twice, and then  
press 1, 2 and 3.  
To select number 2568, press --/--- third, and then  
press 2, 5, 6, and 8.  
To fast forward/reverse the music:  
Press and hold the [  
troller to fast forward the music; press and hold the  
] button to fast reverse the music. When the  
] button on the remote con-  
“No Track”  
The Net-Tune server could not retrieve  
any track information. Register tracks  
with the Net-Tune server.  
[
music track is back at its beginning, normal playing  
starts.  
If you have already registered tracks, use  
the [DISPLAY], [ARTIST], [ALBUM],  
[GENRE], and [PLAYLIST] buttons to  
display information.  
To switch to the track list:  
While playing the music, you can press the [ ] but-  
ton to display a list of currently open tracks.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Selecting a Track List  
Upper case (A) Lower case (a) Numeric value (2)  
... When your desired input type is selected, then  
press the number/letter button.  
Let us take the [2ABC] button as an example to see the  
operation.  
You can use the music le data saved on the Net-Tune  
server to select which tracks to play.  
For example, you can:  
Select a track list based on the album name  
Select a track list based on the artist name  
Select a track list based on the genre name  
Select a play list  
When the upper case is selected:  
Pressing the button once will perform a search by the  
letter A.Pressing twice will do a search by B,press-  
ing three times by C.”  
When the lower case is selected:  
Press either the [ALBUM], [ART-  
IST], [GENRE], or [PLAYLIST] but-  
ton on the remote controller.  
Search the tracks stored on the Net-Tune  
server with your selected mode to display it  
in the display.  
1
Pressing the button once will perform a search by the  
letter a.Pressing twice will do a search by b,press-  
ing three times by c.”  
When the numeric value is selected:  
Pressing the button once will perform a search by the  
numeric value 2.”  
TEST  
T
O
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
In the artist and album modes, the tracks  
are displayed in alphabetical order.  
You can also use the procedure below.  
1. Press the [DISPLAY] button.  
2. You can press the [ ]/[ ] buttons to  
cyclically switch among the four  
modes: Albums Artists Genres  
Playlists.  
To cancel the operation:  
Notes:  
Press the [DELETE] button to delete the entered let-  
ter or number.  
Pressing the [DISPLAY] button on the main unit will  
display the current listening mode.  
3. Press the [ENTER] button.  
Playing a Music File At Random  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
one from the menu.  
At this time, pressing [ ] button brings  
you one step back where you can change  
the selection you made.  
Also, pressing [ ] button in the genre  
or artist selection mode will display a  
list of albums with the genre or artist  
you selected.  
In the album, artist, or playlist selection  
mode, using the number/letter buttons  
will accelerate your selection operation  
(See below).  
2
RANDOM  
Press the [RANDOM] button on the  
remote controller when in stop mode.  
This button displays the current random  
settings and switches between two alter-  
native settings: On and Off.  
On: Randomly plays the tracks in the  
currently selected mode.  
Off: Random mode is disabled.  
After the necessary settings are com-  
plete, press the [ ] button.  
ENTER  
Playing a Music File Repeatedly  
Press the [REPEAT] button on the  
remote controller.  
This button displays the current repeat  
settings and cyclically switches among  
three alternative settings: Repeat 1 →  
All Off.  
Repeat 1: Repeats the current track only.  
Repeat All: Repeats the tracks in the  
currently selected mode.  
Repeat Off: Repeat mode is disabled.  
You can operate the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E when playing and when  
stopped.  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
The title of your selected track appears.  
You can choose another track by pressing  
the [ ]/[ ] buttons.  
Press the [ ] button to return to the pre-  
vious step.  
3
4
PURE A  
REPEAT  
ENTER  
You can also select the list number using  
the number/letter buttons.  
Press the [ENTER] button.  
The playback begins.  
ENTER  
Using the number/letter buttons  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
-
LEVEL  
+
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
Re-EQ  
L
NIGHT  
CAPS  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
The number/letter buttons allow you to input one of the  
letters or numbers printed on their key tops. Pressing the  
[CAPS] button cyclically switches the types of input:  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Conguring the Music Server  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
the Music Serversub-menu,  
then press the [ENTER] button.  
The setup screen for the sub-menu  
appears.  
4
5
ENTER  
The music server settings can be made while you select  
the music server as an input source.  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
ENTER  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
4
5
6
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
7
8
9
Use the [ ] and [ ] cursor but-  
tons to select Select Serverand  
then use the [ ] and [ ] cursor  
buttons to select the desired  
server.  
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
10  
0
ENTER  
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
INPUT  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
Select a network server that exists on the  
TV  
INPUT  
network.  
ENTER,  
/ /  
+
/
* mark appears next to the servers  
detected on the network. If there is a  
server that does not have a * mark, make  
sure that the server is running. Not  
Foundmessage indicates that no server  
is currently available for selection. If the  
message appears, make sure that the  
server is connected and running.  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
SETUP  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
Press the [INPUT] button, and  
then roll the scroll wheel to select  
MSRV.  
Make sure that the MSRVis displayed  
when you congure the music server.  
1
2
INPUT  
Press the [SETUP] button.  
This completes the conguration proce-  
dure and the menu disappears.  
Tips:  
6
Press the scroll wheel, and then  
press the [SETUP] button to dis-  
play the Main Menu.  
When choosing settings on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, after select-  
ing the input source using the input source  
buttons, press the [SETUP] button. Next,  
select the menu you want to congure by  
turning the [SELECT/PRESET] dial and  
press the dial to conrm the selection.  
Then, after selecting the submenu you  
want to congure by turning the  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial, select your  
value by turning the [CONTROL/TUN-  
ING] dial, and press the dial to conrm  
the value. If you want to go back to the  
previous operation, press the [EXIT] but-  
ton.  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
Input Setup,then press the  
[ENTER] button.  
3
ENTER  
ENTER  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enjoying Net Audio—Continued  
Music Server Memo  
Internet Radio Memo  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup Menu  
When making the various settings required to configure your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E for optimum performance,  
you can use either the OSD Menu that appears on your television monitor or you can use the display on the front of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The OSD Menu is a settings menu that is displayed on your TV monitor.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is equipped with an independent Setup Menu not only for Main room A but also for  
Main room B and Zone 2 room, which allows you to specify settings for each room. The Setup Menu includes various  
menus. These menus are then divided into various sub-menus, and these contain settings for you to optimize your home  
theater as you wish.  
The display shown below is an example. The actual contents of your display may differ depending on the model for  
your region and the selected input source.  
For more information on operating instructions, see page 86.  
OSD Map (MAIN A)  
Main menu  
Reference  
pages  
0.Hardware Setup  
Main A Setup  
=====================  
=====================  
0.Hardware Setup  
1.Speaker/Output Setup  
2.Input Setup  
1.Remote Control Setup  
2.TV Format Setup  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
87  
3.AM Frequency Setup  
5.Preference  
6.i.LINK Setup  
7.Network Setup  
8.Lock/Version  
88  
89  
1.Speaker/Output Setup  
=====================  
1.Speaker Configuration  
2.Speaker Impedance  
3.Speaker Crossover  
4.Speaker Distance  
5.Notch Filter  
90  
91  
6.Level Calibration  
7.THX Audio Setup  
92  
8.Audio Output Assign  
9.Video Output Assign  
94  
95  
96  
97  
2.Input Setup  
==Input:XXXXXX=======  
1.Audio Assign  
2.Video Assign  
3.Listening Mode Preset  
4.Character Edit  
5.IntelliVolume  
6.Delay  
98  
7.12V Trigger Assign  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
105  
106  
108  
109  
110  
112  
114  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
=====================  
1.Mono Setup  
2.Multiplex Setup  
3.Stereo Setup  
4.Direct, Pure Audio  
Setup  
5.Multichannel Input  
Setup  
6.i.LINK(IEEE1394)  
:DVD-Audio Input Setup  
7.i.LINK(IEEE1394)  
:SACD Input Setup  
8.Dolby Digital Setup  
9.DTS Setup  
10.AAC Setup  
11.Dolby Pro LogicIIx/  
DTS NEO:6 Setup  
12.THX Setup  
13.Mono Movie Setup  
14.Enhance Setup  
15.Orchestra Setup  
16.Unplugged Setup  
17.Studio-Mix Setup  
18.TV Logic Setup  
19.All Ch Stereo Setup  
20.Full Mono Setup  
21.Dolby Virtual  
Speaker Setup  
115  
116  
117  
*The text appeared with your unit may  
slightly differ than those printed here,  
however there is no difference in items to  
be displayed or meanings in them.  
22.Dolby Headphone  
Setup  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup Menu—Continued  
Reference  
pages  
Main A Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
=====================  
0.Hardware Setup  
1.Speaker/Output Setup  
2.Input Setup  
=====================  
118  
1.Tone Control  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
5.Preference  
6.i.LINK Setup  
7.Network Setup  
8.Lock/Version  
5.Preference  
=====================  
1.Volume Setup  
119  
2.Headphone Level Setup  
3.OSD Setup  
4.OSD Position  
6.i.LINK Setup  
=====================  
1.Wakeup Setup  
2.OSD for DVD  
3.OSD for DVD  
(Zone 2)  
120  
4.DVD Output Synchro  
7.Network Setup  
=====================  
121  
122  
1.IP Address  
2.Proxy  
3.MAC Address  
4.Client  
Save Settings  
8.Lock/Version  
=====================  
1.Lock Setup  
123  
2.Firmware Version  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup Menu—Continued  
OSD Map (MAIN B)  
Reference  
pages  
Main menu  
Main B Setup  
0.Hardware Setup  
=====================  
=====================  
87  
0.Hardware Setup  
1.Speaker Setup  
2.Input Setup  
3.Audio Adjust  
4.Preference  
1.TV Format Setup  
1.Speaker Setup  
=====================  
1.Speaker Impedance  
2.Speaker Crossover  
3.Speaker Distance  
4.Level Calibration  
5.THX Audio Setup  
89  
90  
91  
2.Input Setup  
==Input:XXXXXXXXX====  
96  
98  
1.Listening Mode Preset  
2.Delay  
3.Audio Adjust  
=====================  
1.Tone Control  
118  
4.Preference  
=====================  
1.Volume Setup  
2.OSD Setup  
119  
3.OSD Position  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup Menu—Continued  
OSD Map (ZONE 2)  
Reference  
pages  
The Zone 2 settings shown on this  
page can be made when you  
perform either of the following  
settings in the “MAIN A” setup  
menu.  
0.Hardware Setup  
=====================  
87  
1.TV Format Setup  
• Under the “Speaker/Output  
Setup Speaker Configuration”  
menu, when you select the  
surround back setting to  
“Powered Zone 2.(The main  
menu 1 below)  
• Under the “Speaker/Output  
Setup Audio (Video) Output  
Assign” menu, when you select  
the output terminal setting to  
“Zone 2 Out.(The main menu 2  
below)  
1.Speaker Setup  
=====================  
1.Speaker Impedance  
89  
(Main menu 1)  
2.Input Setup  
Zone 2 Setup  
96  
98  
==Input:XXXXXXXXX====  
=====================  
1.Listening Mode Preset  
2.Delay  
0.Hardware Setup  
1.Speaker Setup  
2.Input Setup  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
5.Preference  
99  
(Main menu 2)  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
=====================  
100  
Zone 2 Setup  
=====================  
1.Mono Setup  
2.Multiplex Setup  
3.Stereo Setup  
4.Dolby Digital Setup  
5.DTS Setup  
0.Hardware Setup  
106  
2.Input Setup  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
5.Preference  
6.AAC Setup  
7.Dolby Virtual  
Speaker Setup  
108  
109  
116  
118  
4.Audio Adjust  
=====================  
1.Tone Control  
5.Preference  
=====================  
1.Volume Setup  
2.OSD Setup  
119  
3.OSD Position  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup Menu—Continued  
Navigating the Setup Menu  
You can change Setup Menu settings using the buttons on the front panel and on the remote controller.  
The illustrations here represent the remote controller.  
OSD  
Main A Setup  
=====================  
0.Hardware Setup  
1.Speaker/Output Setup  
2.Input Setup  
1.Speaker/Output Setup  
=====================  
1.Speaker Configuration  
2.Speaker Impedance  
3.Speaker Crossover  
4.Speaker Distance  
5.Notch Filter  
3.Listening Mode Setup  
4.Audio Adjust  
5.Preference  
6.i.LINK Setup  
7.Network Setup  
8.Lock/Version  
1-1.Speaker Config  
=====================  
Speaker A  
a.Front L/R :Main A  
6.Level Calibration  
7.THX Audio Setup  
b.Center  
:Main A  
8.Audio Output Assign  
9.Video Output Assign  
Front panel  
dispaly  
c.Surr L/R :Main A  
d.Surr Back  
:Main A 2ch  
e.Subwoofer :Main A  
Main menu  
Menu  
Sub-menu  
Press the [SETUP] button.  
The main menu appears on your television  
monitor.  
3
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
I
INPUT  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
+
TV CH  
-
@.  
-
'/  
Using the [ ] and [ ] cursor buttons,  
select the menu that you want to enter.  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
4
5
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
/
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
Press the [ENTER] button to enter the  
selected menu.  
The screen for that menu appears.  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
ZONE 2  
Scroll wheel  
MODE  
INPUT  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
Use the [ ] and [ ] cursor buttons to  
select the sub-menu that you want to  
enter and press the [ENTER] button.  
INPUT  
6
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
Each sub-menu has different settings that can be  
changed as desired, and they are all explained in  
the pages that follow. To change a setting, rst  
select it using the [ ] and [ ] cursor buttons,  
and then change the setting using the [ ] and  
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
SETUP/  
ENTER/  
RETURN/  
Cursor  
REC  
MAIN  
A
MAIN  
B
RANDOM  
MAIN A,  
MAIN B  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST  
M
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
STEREO  
[
] cursor buttons.  
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
/
/
/
-
+
Press the [SETUP] button to exit the Setup  
Menu.  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
7
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
Press the [RETURN] button to set the new  
settings and return to the previous menu.  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
When you perform settings using the buttons on the  
front panel, press the [SETUP] button rst. Use the  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial instead of the [ ]/[ ] buttons  
to select menus or parameters and press the dial to  
conrm your selection. Then use the [CONTROL/  
TUNING] dial instead of the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
your setting or parameter values and press the dial to  
conrm your selection. In addition, the [EXIT] button is  
used instead of the [RETURN] button.  
Press the scroll wheel when using the  
remote controller.  
1
2
Press the button of the room where you  
want to perform operations.  
Press [MAIN A], [MAIN B], or [ZONE 2].  
If the room where you want to perform operations  
has already been activated, you do not have to press  
the button here. Pressing the button while the  
corresponding room is activated deactivates the  
room for setup.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hardware Setup  
In this section, you will perform the initial settings for the following scenarios.  
When you want to change the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote control ID.  
When you want to x the TV Format setting to PAL or NTSC.  
When you want to x the AM Frequency Step setting to 9 kHz or 10 kHz.  
Remote Control Setup Sub-menu  
AM Frequency Setup Sub-menu  
(Asian and Australian Models Only)  
Remote ID  
Frequency Step  
This section explains how to change the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es remote control ID. You may need to  
change this if the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote  
controller interferes with other Onkyo components  
located in the same room. You can select 1, 2, or 3 for  
remote control ID.  
The setting in this sub-menu determines the incremental  
or decremental amount when adjusting the AM tuner  
frequency. The initial setting is 9 kHz, and this only  
needs to be changed if you are using the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E in a 10 kHz region.  
If you change the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote  
control ID, be sure to select the same ID on the remote  
controller (See page 142). The default ID for both the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and remote controller is 1.  
9 kHz: Select if 9 kHz increments are used in your area.  
10 kHz: Select if 10 kHz increments are used in your  
area.  
Note:  
It is recommended that you perform setup using the  
[SETUP]/[SELECT/PRESET]/[CONTROL/TUNING]/  
[EXIT] buttons of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es  
front panel.  
If the remote controller is used for setup, signals from  
the remote controller will not be received just after the  
remote control ID settings have been changed (See  
Changing the Remote Controllers Control IDon  
page 142 to change the remote control ID on the remote  
controller).  
TV Format Sub-menu  
TV Format (for all models other than USA and  
Canadian models)  
The settings in the TV Format sub-menu can be  
congured for Main B and Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
When you want to recongure the settings to conform  
to the television format used in the area where you use  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, use this sub-menu so  
that no time is wasted on detection.  
Auto: This is the default setting. When you leave this  
setting unchanged, the television format is detected and  
automatically set by the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
PAL: Use this setting when you know the television  
format is PAL.  
NTSC: Use this setting when you know the television  
format is NTSC.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker/Output Setup  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E provides a wide range of variations in speaker connections and speaker settings, so you  
have to specify speaker settings according to conditions of each variation. For proper selection of an AV device  
connected at switching of the input type, you also need to allocate audio outputand video outputto each input type.  
If this allocation is incorrect, the desired component will not play a selected input source.  
Please setup correctly by referring to the information you wrote down in the Your System Setting booklet.  
(Speaker A) Subwoofer  
Speaker Conguration Sub-menu  
Main A (default): Select this when using a subwoofer  
Specify the rooms where you want to use speakers  
in the main room A.  
connected to the SPEAKERS A terminal and the  
Not Used: Select this when not using a subwoofer in  
SPEAKERS B terminal. Specify according to settings  
the main room A.  
for main room A.  
(Speaker B) Front L/R  
Note:  
Basically, a speaker set with the maximum number of  
speakers should be connected to the SPEAKERS A  
terminals and congured for main room A (Main A).  
When either the center, surround, or surround back  
speakers are not connected to the SPEAKERS A  
terminals, or any of these speakers is set to Not Used”  
in the Speaker A settings, you cannot perform the  
settings for the corresponding speakers connected to the  
SPEAKERS B terminals and those speakers connected  
to the SPEAKERS B terminals cannot be used.  
Main A: Select this when using in main room A.  
Main B: Select this when using in main room B.  
Not Used (default): Select this when not using.  
(Speaker B) Center  
Main A: Select this when using in main room A.  
Main B: Select this when using in main room B. This  
setting can only be made when you set the (Speaker B)  
Front L/Rsetting to Main B.”  
Not Used (default): Select this when not using.  
(Speaker A) Front L/R  
(Speaker B) Surr L/R  
The setting of the front speakers is initially xed to  
Main A.  
Always install speakers connected to FRONT L/R of  
SPEAKERS A in main room A.  
Main A: Select this when using in main room A.  
Main B: Select this when using in main room B. This  
setting can only be made when you set the (Speaker B)  
Front L/Rsetting to Main B.”  
Not Used (default): Select this when not using.  
(Speaker A) Center, Surr L/R  
Main A (default): Select this when using the center  
speaker and/or surround speakers in main room A.  
Not Used: Select this when not using a center speaker  
or surround speakers.  
(Speaker B) Surr Back  
MainA 2ch: Select this when connecting and using two  
surround back speakers in main room A.  
Main A 1ch (SBL): Select this when connecting and  
using a surround back speaker in main room A.  
Main B 2ch: If (Speaker B) Front L/R and Surr L/R are  
both set to Main B,you can select this item. Select  
this when connecting and using two surround back  
speakers in main room B.  
Main B 1ch (SBL): If (Speaker B) Front L/R and Surr  
L/R are both set to Main B,you can select this item.  
Select this when connecting and using a surround back  
speaker in main room B.  
Powered Zone 2: Select this when using in Zone 2.  
If (Speaker A) Surr Back is set to BTL for Frontor  
Bi-Amp for Front,this item is not displayed  
(Because, if Powered Zone 2is set, BTL  
connection and/or Bi-Amp connection are disabled).  
BTL for Front: This setting can be made only when  
you set the (Speaker B) Front L/Rsetting to Main A”  
or Main B.Select this when using the front speaker in  
main room B by connecting the surround back channel  
to the speaker via BTL (See page 27).  
(Speaker A) Surr Back  
Main A 2ch (default): If Surr L/R is set to Main A,”  
you can select this item. Select this when connecting  
and using two surround back speakers in main room A.  
Main A 1ch (SBL): If Surr L/R is set to Main A,you  
can select this item. Select this when connecting and  
using a surround back speaker in main room A.  
BTL for Front: Select this when using the front  
speaker in main room A by connecting the surround  
back channel to the speaker via BTL (See page 27).  
Bi-Amp for Front: Select this when using the front  
speaker in main room A by connecting the front channel  
and the surround back channel to the speaker via Bi-  
Amp (See page 27).  
Not Used: Select this when not using surround back  
speakers.  
Note:  
If Not Usedis selected for Surr L/R, this item defaults  
to Not Used.”  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker/Output Setup—Continued  
Bi-Amp for Front: This setting can be made only when  
you set the “(Speaker B) Front L/R” setting to “Main A”  
or “Main B.” Select this when using the front speaker in  
main room B by connecting the front channel and the  
surround back channel to the speaker via Bi-Amp (See  
page 28).  
Speaker Crossover Sub-menu  
The settings in the Speaker Crossover sub-menu can be  
configured for both “Main A” and “Main B.”  
Front L/R, Center, Surr L/R, Surr Back  
Not Used (default): Select this when not using  
surround back speakers.  
Specify a threshold frequency in Hz for bass sounds  
from each speaker to be output from the subwoofer.  
When no subwoofer is used, (Speaker A) Front L/R is  
automatically set to “Full Band,” and bass sounds from  
each speaker are output from the front speakers. You  
can also set other speakers to “Full Band.”  
You can specify the frequency at 10 Hz increments  
between 40-150 Hz. When using a THX-Select-certified  
speaker system, specify the setting of 80 Hz (THX)  
(default).  
Note:  
If (Speaker A) Surr Back is set to “Main A 1ch,” you  
cannot select “Main A 2ch” and “Main B 2ch” here.  
(Speaker B) Subwoofer  
This setting can be made only when you set the  
“(Speaker B) Front L/R” setting to “Main A” or “Main  
B.”  
• If you specify the frequency of the front speakers  
between 40-150 Hz, you cannot select “Full Band”  
for the other speakers.  
• For any speaker that is not available or set to “Not  
Used” in the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, no  
associated setting item is displayed.  
• If “Surr Back” is set to “BTL for Front” or “Bi-Amp  
for Front” on the Speaker Configuration sub-menu,  
no item for surround back speakers is displayed.  
Main A: Select this when using a subwoofer in main  
room B.  
Main B: Select this when using a subwoofer in main  
room B. This setting can only be made when you set the  
“(Speaker B) Front L/R” setting to “Main B.”  
Not Used (default): Select this when not using a  
subwoofer.  
When the settings for Speaker Configuration are  
completed, the subsequent settings should be speci-  
fied separately in main room A, main room B, and  
Zone 2.  
LPF of LFE (setting of the low-pass filter for LFE)  
Specify the low-pass filter for LFE (Low Frequency  
Effect).  
The low-pass filter passes through only the signal  
components below the specified frequency, eliminating  
the unwanted noise.  
Speaker Impedance Sub-menu  
Use this sub-menu to set the impedance level of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to match the specifications  
of the speakers you are using. The settings in the  
Speaker Impedance sub-menu can be configured for  
Main B and Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can specify the frequency at 10 Hz increments  
between 40-150 Hz.  
The selectable parameters are common to all items.  
SW Mode (Subwoofer Mode)  
Note:  
This item is displayed when a subwoofer is used (any  
item other than “Not Used” is selected for Subwoofer  
on the Speaker Configuration sub-menu), and Front L/R  
is set to “Full Band” on the Speaker Crossover sub-  
menu. Set the sound from the subwoofer to any of the  
following:  
LFE only: The subwoofer outputs only LFE (Low  
Frequency Effect) information.  
D. Bass: The subwoofer outputs not only LFE (Low  
Frequency Effect) factors but also bass sounds from the  
front speakers.  
Before you change this setting, be sure to first lower  
the volume at the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to the  
minimum level.  
8 ohms (default): Select this when the impedance of  
the connected speaker is 8 ohms or more.  
6 ohms: Select this when the impedance of the  
connected speaker is no lower than 6 ohms and  
no higher than 8 ohms.  
4 ohms: Select this when the impedance of the  
connected speaker is no lower than 4 ohms and  
no higher than 6 ohms.  
• When “BTL for Front” is selected for “Surr Back”  
from the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, the  
corresponding “Front L/R” is automatically fixed to  
“8 ohms,” and the impedance settings for the  
surround back speakers are also removed. Please  
verify that the impedance of a connected speaker is 8  
ohms or more.  
• For any speaker that is not available or set to “Not  
Used” in the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, no  
associated setting item is displayed.  
Speaker Distance Sub-menu  
Measure the distance between the listening position and  
each speaker. Specifying the distance will synchronize  
the speakers in terms of the time that sounds from each  
speaker reach the listening position. This is an  
important specification for you to enjoy realistic home  
theater. The settings in the Speaker Distance sub-menu  
can be configured for both “Main A” and “Main B.”  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker/Output Setup—Continued  
Perform the setup procedure below following the  
operating instructions described on page 86.  
1. Select the unit of distance from “Unit.”  
You can select either “feet” or “meters.” The default  
varies depending on the region.  
2. Set the distance you measured. Enter all the values  
for every speaker you connected.  
Depth  
When setting “Notch Filter” above to “On,” the notch  
filter becomes effective at the value you specify.  
You can specify intervals of 0.5 dB in a range from  
–15 dB to 0 dB. The default is –10 dB.  
Width  
• For any speaker that is not available or set to “Not  
Used” in the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, no  
associated setting item is displayed.  
• If “Surr Back” is set to “BTL for Front” or “Bi-Amp  
for Front” on the Speaker Configuration sub-menu,  
no item for surround back speakers is displayed.  
When “feet” is selected:  
The available setting values are calculated based on  
the values specified in the “Frequency” and “Depth”  
settings above. You can choose any values according  
to your favorite sound.  
Level Calibration Sub-menu  
Use this sub-menu to set the volume for each speaker so  
that each volume is heard by the listener at the same  
level. This is especially important for speaker layouts  
where the left and right speakers are at different distances  
or in asymmetrical positions due to room designs and  
configurations. These settings and the distance settings  
performed in the Speaker Distance sub-menu are vital for  
creating proper sound space and dynamics. The settings  
in the Level Calibration sub-menu can be configured for  
both “Main A” and “Main B.”  
Front L, Center, Front R, and Subwoofer can be set at  
0.1 foot intervals in a range from 1.0 foot to 30.0 feet.  
The default is 12.0 feet.  
Surr R, Surr Back (or Surr Bk R and Surr Bk L), and  
Surr L can be set at 0.1 foot intervals in a range from 1.0  
foot to 30.0 feet. The default is 7.0 feet.  
When “meters” is selected:  
Front L, Center, Front R, and Subwoofer can be set at  
0.03 meter intervals in a range from 0.30 meters to 9.00  
meters. The default is 3.60 meters.  
• These settings cannot be made when the sound is  
muted, when you connect the headphones, and when  
you use multichannel playback.  
Surr R, Surr Back (or Surr Bk R and Surr Bk L), and  
Surr L can be set at 0.03 meter intervals in a range from  
0.30 meters to 9.00 meters. The default is 2.10 meters.  
You cannot use the [MASTER VOLUME] dial while  
you perform the Level Calibration settings. These  
settings are intended to bring sound levels between  
speakers into balance so as to obtain the proper sound  
space.  
This unit supports the THX format and the test  
tone is output at a standard 0 dB (the Absolute  
Volume value is 82). If you usually enjoy listening  
at a lower level than the test tone, be careful of the  
test tone’s sudden loud sound. Note that the test  
tone will be output immediately after pressing the  
[ENTER] button in step 1 below.  
1. When you display this setting screen, select “Level  
Calibration,” and press the [ENTER] button, the dis-  
play changes to the Level Calibration screen, and at  
the same time, a sound is emitted from the front left  
speaker.  
Notch Filter Sub-menu  
To configure the settings under the Notch Filter sub-  
menu, a special measuring device is required. Usually,  
leave these settings to their defaults, “Off.”  
A notch filter cuts the signal of certain frequency ranges  
and passes the rest of the signal through. Some  
characteristics due to a room's environmental elements,  
including walls and smallness of the room, cause a  
signal peak in certain low frequencies to occur at the  
resonance frequency, resulting in a boomy sound. The  
filter reduces the signal at these frequencies causing the  
boomy sound.  
To know which frequency the peak occurs at, use a low  
frequency sine wave generator and SPL (Sound  
Pressure Level) meter to check the frequency and the  
notch value.  
2. Starting with the front speaker, press the [ ]/[  
buttons to select a speaker, and press the [ ]/[  
]
]
Notch Filter  
buttons to set the volume level. When you have set all  
connected speakers, the setup is complete.  
You can adjust in the range from –12 dB to +12 dB in  
0.5 dB step. The subwoofer can be adjusted in the range  
from –15dB to +12 dB in 0.5 dB step.  
• For any speaker that is not available or set to “Not  
Used” in the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, no  
associated setting item is displayed.  
• If “Surr Back is set to “BTL for Front” or “Bi-Amp  
for Front” on the Speaker Configuration sub-menu,  
no item for surrund back speakers is displayed.  
Off (Default): Select this setting when not applying the  
notch filter.  
On: Select this setting when applying the notch filter.  
Frequency  
When setting “Notch Filter” above to “On,” the notch  
filer becomes effective at the frequency you specify  
here. With your measuring device, the frequency value  
can be set at 1 Hz intervals in a range from 20 Hz to 300  
Hz. The default is 100 Hz.  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker/Output Setup—Continued  
1-4 ft (0.3-1.2 m): This is the setting when the distance  
between speakers is 1-4 feet (30 cm-1.2 m).  
>4 ft (1.2 m): This is the setting when the distance  
between speakers is 4 feet (1.2 m) or more.  
*ASA: Advanced Speaker Array  
THX Audio Setup Sub-menu  
This is for setting up a home theater with a THX-Ultra2  
compliant speaker system. These settings will be  
effective in the listening mode for the THX Ultra2  
Cinema and THX Music Mode. The settings in the THX  
Audio Setup sub-menu can be configured for both  
“Main A” and “Main B.”  
Audio Output Assign Sub-menu  
This setting allocates audio output jacks on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to input (play) sources. The  
setting varies depending on the connection conditions.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is equipped with  
analog output jacks for five lines, and digital output  
jacks: optical jacks (OPT) for two lines, and coaxial  
jacks (COAX) for two lines. If setting the analog jacks  
to “Zone 2 Out” or “Zone 3 Out,” you can also specify  
whether output should be variable or fixed.  
THX Ultra2 Subwoofer A/  
THX Ultra2 Subwoofer B  
This is for setting the connected subwoofer. Select  
Yes” or “No” according to your subwoofer’s  
specification.  
Yes: Set “Yes” if your subwoofer conforms to the THX  
Ultra2 standard or if the playback capability of its bass  
range extends down to 20 Hz. Otherwise, set “No.”  
No (Default): Set “No” if you use any subwoofer that  
does not fit the conditions above.  
The default settings are as follows:  
Terminals  
Analog 1 (AUDIO OUT 1)  
Analog 2 (AUDIO OUT 2)  
Analog 3 (AUDIO OUT 3)  
Analog 4 (AUDIO OUT 4)  
Analog 5 (AUDIO OUT 5)  
Default input settings  
Video 1 Rec Out  
Video 2 Rec Out  
Video 3 Rec Out  
Zone 2 Out  
• For any speaker that is not available or set to “Not  
Used” in the Speaker Configuration sub-menu, no  
associated setting item is displayed.  
Boundary Gain Compensation A/  
Boundary Gain Compensation B  
Zone 3 Out  
Opt 1 Out (DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1) Tape 1 Rec Out  
Opt 2 Out (DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 2) Tape 2 Rec Out  
Coax 1 Out (DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1) Video 1 Rec Out  
Coax 2 Out (DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 2) Zone 2 Out  
This is for setting the correction of boundary gains.  
This item can be set when “THX Ultra2 Subwoofer” is  
set to “Yes.”  
Room boundaries (walls) or other characteristics (such  
as construction materials) may increase the perceived  
acoustics levels at low frequencies. Depending on the  
listener’s and the subwoofer’s position, the listener may  
experience an excessive bass effect.  
The purpose of this feature is to compensate for  
excessive bass resulting from a boundary gain effect.  
On: Boundary Gain Compensation is applied.  
Off (Default): Boundary Gain Compensation is not  
applied.  
Analog 1-5  
Set the analog audio output jacks of “AUDIO OUT 1-5.”  
You can select from Tape 1 Rec Out, Tape 2 Rec Out,  
Video 1 Rec Out, Video 2 Rec Out, Video 3 Rec Out,  
Zone 2 Out, Zone 3 Out, and Not Used.  
AUDIO  
1
2
3
4
5
Distance Between Surr Back A SP/  
Distance Between Surr Back B SP  
R
L
R
L
OUT  
Example 1:  
This setting is allowed only when “Main 2ch” is  
selected from the Speaker Configuration sub-menu.  
Place two surround back speakers as close together as  
possible, measure the distance, and set the value (See  
the figure). The maximum effects will be realized by  
THX’s ASA* technology.  
When input (REC) of a sound recording device (e.g., a  
cassette deck) with TAPE 1 as an input source is  
connected to AUDIO OUT 1, set “Analog 1” to “Tape 1  
Rec Out.”  
Example 2:  
When sound input of a picture recording device (e.g., a  
VCR) with VIDEO 1 as an input source is connected to  
AUDIO OUT 2, set “Analog 2” to “Video 1 Rec Out.”  
Example 3:  
When the amplifier for Zone 2 is connected to AUDIO  
OUT 5, set “Analog 5” to “Zone 2 Out.”  
When nothing is connected: Select “Not Used.”  
0-1 ft (0-0.3 m)(Default): This is the setting when the  
distance between the speakers is 0-1 foot (0-30 cm).  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speaker/Output Setup—Continued  
Zone 2 Out, Zone 3 Out  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is equipped with  
composite video output jacks for four lines, and S video  
output jacks for four lines.  
This item is displayed when “Zone 2 Out” or “Zone 3  
Out” is specified for Analog 1-5 above. The default  
setting for “Zone 2 Out” is “Pre Out (variable)” and for  
“Zone 3 Out” is “Line Out (fixed).”  
1
3
2
4
Pre Out (variable): Select this when you want to set  
“variable” for output to a device connected to Zone 2 or  
Zone 3. You should operate the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E to adjust the sound volume from the  
device in Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
Line Out (fixed): Select this when you want to set  
“fixed” for output to a device connected to Zone 2 or  
Zone 3. You should operate the amplifier connected to  
the terminal to adjust the sound volume from the device  
in Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
The default settings are as follows:  
Terminals  
Default input settings  
Monitor Out B  
Composite Video 1 (VIDEO OUT 1)  
Composite Video 2 (VIDEO OUT 2)  
Composite Video 3 (VIDEO OUT 3)  
Composite Video 4 (VIDEO OUT 4)  
S-Video 1 (S VIDEO OUT 1)  
S-Video 2 (S VIDEO OUT 2)  
S-Video 3 (S VIDEO OUT 3)  
S-Video 4 (S VIDEO OUT 4)  
Zone 2 Out  
Zone 3 Out  
Monitor Out A (fixed)  
Video 1 Rec Out  
Video 2 Rec Out  
Video 3 Rec Out  
Monitor Out A (fixed)  
Opt 1 Out, Opt 2 Out, Coax 1 Out, Coax 2 Out  
Specify a setting for “DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1-2”  
and “DIGITAL OUT COAXIAL 1-2.”  
You can select from Tape 1 Rec Out, Tape 2 Rec Out,  
Video 1 Rec Out, Video 2 Rec Out, Video 3 Rec Out,  
Composite Video 1-3, S-Video 1-3  
This is a setting for the composite video output jacks  
(VIDEO OUT 1-3) and S video output jacks (S VIDEO  
OUT 1-3).  
For Composite Video 1-3, you can select from Monitor  
Out A, Monitor Out B, Video 1 Rec Out, Video 2 Rec  
Out, Video 3 Rec Out, Zone 2 Out, Zone 3 Out, and Not  
Used.  
You can set “Zone 2 Out” or “Zone 3 Out” only when  
“Zone 2 Out” or “Zone 3 Out” is selected from the  
Audio Output Assign sub-menu.  
For S Video 1-3, you can select from Monitor Out A,  
Monitor Out B, Video 1 Rec Out, Video 2 Rec Out,  
Video 3 Rec Out, and Not Used.  
Zone 2 Out, Zone 3 Out, and Not Used.  
DIGITAL  
1
2
1
2
OUT  
Example 1:  
When input (REC) of an audio recording device (e.g.,  
an MD recorder) with TAPE 2 as an input source is  
connected to DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 1, set “Opt 1  
Out” to “Tape 2 Rec Out.”  
Example 2:  
When input (IN) of a picture recording device (e.g., a  
DVD recorder) with VIDEO 2 as an input source is  
connected to DIGITAL OUT OPTICAL 2, set “Opt 2  
Out” to “Video 2 Rec Out.”  
Example 1:  
When the video port of a picture recording device (e.g.,  
a VCR) with VIDEO 1 as an input source is connected  
to VIDEO OUT 2, you should set “Composite Video 2”  
to “Video 1 Rec Out.”  
When nothing is connected: Select “Not Used.”  
HDMI Out  
Example 2:  
This setting allows you to enable/disable audio output  
from the HDMI terminal. Use this setting when the  
HDMI terminal of a TV is connected to the HDMI  
terminal of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and you  
want to enable HDMI audio output of the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E from the TV speakers. Usually leave this  
setting to its default, “Disable.”  
When you want to connect a TV set to VIDEO OUT 3  
to watch it in main room A, set “Composite Video 3” to  
“Monitor Out A.”  
When nothing is connected: Select “Not Used.”  
Composite Video 4, S-Video 4  
The composite video output jacks (VIDEO OUT 4), and  
S video output jacks (S VIDEO OUT 4) are fixed to  
Monitor Out A, you cannot change this setting. You  
should connect a TV set and a projector used in main  
room A to VIDEO OUT 4 or S VIDEO OUT 4.  
Disable (Default): Disables HDMI audio output.  
Enable: Enables HDMI audio output.  
Video Output Assign Sub-menu  
This setting allocates video output jacks on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to input (play) sources. The  
setting varies depending on the connection conditions.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup  
Items described here are set when you press the input source buttons.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is equipped with several types of jacks in addition to the standard audio and video jacks,  
and multiple jacks are provided for each type.You may freely assign input sources such as CD, PHONO, TUNER, TAPE  
1, TAPE 2, and VIDEO 1-7 to these jacks.  
Moreover, you can preset a listening mode, specify names for display, adjust audio delays, correct the difference in the  
volume level from other input sources, and set the 12V trigger.  
In particular, please be careful when setting the input jacks. Please properly specify settings for correct selection of  
pictures and audio to be played by referring to the information you wrote down in the Your System Setting booklet.  
In the case of NET AUDIO, you can specify settings for the server (See page 95).  
Settings defaults are as follows:  
OSD Indication  
Audio Assign  
Video Assign  
S-Video Component  
Video  
Analog Audio Multichannel Digital Audio  
i.LINK  
iLINK  
Composite  
Video  
HDMI  
Name of Terminal  
to be Set  
AUDIO IN  
MULTI-CH DIGITAL IN  
IN  
VIDEO IN S VIDEO IN COMPONENT HDMI IN  
VIDEO IN  
NET AUDIO  
CD  
No  
No  
2
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
1
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
1
Last  
Last  
Last  
Last  
1
Opt 2  
No  
PHONO  
TUNER  
TAPE 1  
TAPE 2  
DVD  
Phono  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Last  
Last  
No  
No  
Last  
Last  
2
Opt 3  
Coax 1  
Opt 1  
Coax 2  
Coax 3  
Opt 4  
Opt 5  
Coax 4  
Coax 5  
Last  
Last  
3
Last  
Last  
4
RCA 1  
RCA 2  
RCA 3  
RCA 4/BNC  
No  
HDMI 1  
HDMI 2  
Video  
Video  
Video  
Video  
Video  
Video  
VIDEO 1  
VIDEO 2  
VIDEO 3  
VIDEO 4  
VIDEO 5  
VIDEO 6  
VIDEO 7  
5
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
2
2
6
3
3
7
4
4
8
5
No  
No  
5
9
No  
6
No  
No  
No  
Front (fixed)  
Front Opt  
(fixed)  
Front (fixed) Front (fixed)  
No  
Note: Defaults may differ depending on your region.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup—Continued  
Follow procedures below to change any setting:  
4. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Audio Assign”  
from the sub-menu, and then press the [ENTER]  
button.  
5. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Analog Audio,”  
and then use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select 1.”  
6. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Digital Audio,”  
and then use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Coax 2.”  
7. Press the [RETURN] button to return to the sub-menu.  
8. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Video Assign, ”  
and then press the [ENTER] button.  
9. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select S-Video,and  
then use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select 2.”  
10. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Component  
Video,and then use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
RCA 2.”  
Press the [INPUT] button, and then roll the  
scroll wheel to select the input source that  
you want to set.  
1
Press the scroll wheel, and then press the  
[SETUP] button.  
2
The Main Menu appears onscreen.  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Input  
Setup,and then press the [ENTER]  
button.  
3
The sub-menu is displayed.  
2.Input Setup  
==Input:XXXXXX=======  
11. Press the [SETUP] button.  
1.Audio Assign  
2.Video Assign  
Setting is completed and the menu screen disap-  
pears.  
3.Listening Mode Preset  
4.Character Edit  
5.IntelliVolume  
6.Delay  
7.Picture Setting  
8.12V Trigger Assign  
Audio Assign Sub-menu (when input  
is other than NET AUDIO)  
The following are settings for audio. When input is  
NET AUDIO,see the following page.  
Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select an item  
4
you want to set, and then use the [ ]/[  
buttons to set the desired value.  
]
Analog Audio  
Other items should be selected in the same way.  
The following are settings for analog audio output:  
Phono: Select the device connected to AUDIO IN  
PH.”  
1-9: Select the device connected to the jack of AUDIO  
IN 1-9.”  
Press the [RETURN] button.  
The display returns to the sub-menu.  
5
6
Repeat procedures 4-5 to set desired  
items sequentially.  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
When all of the items are set, go to procedure 7.  
Multichannel  
Press the [SETUP] button.  
Settings are completed and the menu screen disappears.  
1: Select the device connected to the jack of MULTI-  
CH IN 1.”  
7
2: Select the device connected to the jack of MULTI-  
CH IN 2.”  
No (Default): Select this when no device is connected.  
Hint:  
When you perform the procedures on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, after selecting the input source using the  
input source buttons, press the [SETUP] button. Next,  
select the menu you want to congure by turning the  
[SELECT/PRESET] dial and press the dial to conrm  
the selection. Then, after selecting the sub-menu you  
want to congure by turning the [SELECT/PRESET]  
dial, select your value by turning the [CONTROL/  
TUNING] dial, and press the dial to conrm the value.  
If you want to go back to the previous operation, press  
the [EXIT] button.  
Surr Back Channel  
The following are settings for Multichannel 1or  
Multichannel 2described above, and cannot be  
specied separately for each input source. For example,  
when the input source is CD and Surrond Back  
Channelis set to Not Used (5.1 ch)for  
Multichannel 1,switching the input source to DVD  
and Surround Back Channelto SBL/SBR (7.1ch)”  
will also change Surround Back Channelassociated  
with CD to SBL/SBR (7.1ch).”  
Example 1  
In assignment of a DVD recorder to input of VIDEO 1,  
when the analog audio input is connected to VIDEO  
1,the digital audio to COAXIAL 2,and the video to  
S VIDEO 2and COMPONENT 2.”  
Not Used (5.1 ch): Select this when not using the  
surround back channel.  
SBL/SBR (7.1 ch) (Default): Select this when using  
the surround back channel.  
1. Press the [INPUT] button, and then roll the scroll  
wheel to select VIDEO 1.”  
2. Press the scroll wheel, and then press the [SETUP]  
button to display the Main Menu.  
3. Use the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select Input Setup,”  
and then press the [ENTER] button.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup—Continued  
Subwoofer Sensitivity  
Music Server Sub-menu (When input  
is NET AUDIO)  
The following are also settings for “Multichannel 1” or  
“Multichannel 2” (cannot be specified separately for  
each input source).  
Select Server  
Some DVD decks output the LFE channel at –15 dB  
lower than the other channels in the multichannel  
output.  
The level setting under the Level Calibration sub-menu  
is applied to the analog and digital inputs as well as the  
multichannel input. Therefore, in this setting, you can  
set the optimum LFE channel level applied only to the  
multichannel input.  
When input Music Server is selected from NET  
AUDIO, you can specify a server to be connected (See  
page 78).  
Video Assign Sub-menu  
The following are settings for video.  
Composite Video  
You can select from 0 (Default), +5, +10 and +15 dB.  
1-6: Select the device connected to the “VIDEO IN 1-  
6” jack.  
Last: Select this when you want video signal from the  
device you last selected to be output.  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
Digital Audio  
The following are settings for digital audio output.  
Opt 1-Opt 6: Select the device connected to “DIGITAL  
IN OPTICAL 1-6.”  
Coax 1-Coax 6: Select the device connected to  
“DIGITAL IN COAXIAL 1-6.”  
S-Video  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
1-6: Select the device connected to the “S VIDEO IN 1-  
6” jack.  
Last: Select this when you want video signal from the  
device you last selected to be output.  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
Digital Format  
For digital connections, you can set the digital signals to  
be detected preferentially. When “Digital Audio” is set  
to “No” on the Audio Assign Sub-menu above, this item  
is not displayed.  
Component Video  
Auto: Automatically detects the format of input signals.  
The signal format (Dolby Digital, DTS, PCM, AAC,  
etc.) used for the selected source is automatically  
detected, and necessary decoding is performed.  
DTS: Select for DTS decoding.You should select this if  
you feel it takes too long to detect the signals when you  
have selected “Auto,” or if you dislike noises caused by  
CDs fast forwarding or rewinding.  
If any sound other than DTS is input, there is no sound.  
PCM: Select for PCM decoding. You should select this  
if you dislike omission of the top of a subsequent tune  
when you have selected “Auto.”  
RCA 1-4: Select the device connected to the  
“COMPONENT VIDEO IN 1-4” jack.  
BNC (European and Asian models only): Select the  
device connected to the “COMPONENT VIDEO IN”  
BNC type jack.  
Last: Select this when you want video signal from the  
device you last selected to be output.  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
HDMI  
1: Select the device connected to the “HDMI IN 1”  
jack. When selecting this, the video signal from the  
HDMI IN 1 terminal will also be output to the HDMI  
OUT terminal.  
2: Select the device connected to the “HDMI IN 2”  
jack. When selecting this, the video signal from the  
HDMI IN 2 terminal will also be output to the HDMI  
OUT terminal.  
VIDEO: Select this when you want the video signal  
such as Composite Video, S Video, and Component  
Video to be output from the HDMI OUT terminal.  
Last: Select this when you want video signal from the  
device you last selected to be output.  
If any sound other than PCM is input, there is no sound.  
Note:  
When playing any DTS-type CD or LD, always select  
“Auto” and “DTS.” Selecting “PCM” will cause noises.  
i.LINK  
When you connect multiple devices using the i.LINK  
(AUDIO) interface, the device names in the i.LINK  
connection appear and you can choose the input device  
from them using the cursor ([ ]/[ ]) buttons. The  
device selected here will be the preferred device among  
the connected i.LINK (AUDIO) devices.  
No: Select this when no device is connected.  
No: Select this when connected i.LINK (AUDIO)  
devices are not selected as input devices.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup—Continued  
(Zone 2)  
Listening Mode Preset Sub-menu  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
You can specify a listening mode you frequently use for  
each input source.  
AAC  
When a picture you like and frequently watch is a  
Dolby Digital source, for example, you may specify  
Dolby Digital,and if a CD of classical music you are  
fond of is a PCM source, you can specify Pure Audio.”  
Selecting Lastwill set the same listening mode as the  
one you last specied for that source.  
If Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for  
Front,or Not Usedon the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the option PL IIxis set to PL II.”  
If Surr L/Ris set to Not Usedon the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, you cannot select THX,  
Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged,  
Studio-Mix, or TV Logic.  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
AAC signals. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, AAC (Default),  
THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged,  
Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full Mono,  
Dolby VS, and Last.  
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
i.LINK (IEEE1394):DVD-Audio  
If both of Centerand Surr L/Rare set to Not  
Usedon the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, you  
cannot select THX, Mono Movie, Enhance,  
Orchestra, Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch  
Stereo, or Full Mono.  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
DVD-Audio on a device connected to the i.LINK  
(AUDIO) terminal.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, DVD-Audio  
(Default), THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra,  
Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full  
Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
Analog/PCM  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
PCM signals from CDs and analog signals from records  
and casstte tapes. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo (Default), Mono, PL IIx/  
NEO:6, THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra,  
Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full  
Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
i.LINK (IEEE1394):SACD  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
Super Audio CD on a device connected to the i.LINK  
(AUDIO) terminal.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, SACD (Default),  
THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged,  
Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full Mono,  
Dolby VS, and Last.  
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
Dolby Digital  
D.F.2ch  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
Dolby Digital signals. This option can be set for Main B  
and Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby Digital  
(Default), THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra,  
Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full  
Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
digital signals such as Dolby Digital recorded through  
two channels. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as the Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, PLIIx/NEO:6  
(Default), THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra,  
Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full  
Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
(Zone 2)  
DTS  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
DTS signals. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, DTS (Default),  
THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged,  
Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full Mono,  
Dolby VS, and Last.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup—Continued  
D.F. Mono  
Character  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
digital signals such as Dolby Digital and AAC recorded  
in monaural. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
When Yesis selected for Character Displayabove,  
you can name the input source.  
You are allowed to enter up to ten characters.  
Carry out the following operations on the Character  
Input screen:  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono (Default), Mono  
Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged, Studio-Mix,  
TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full Mono, Dolby VS, and  
Last.  
2-4.Character Input  
Input:VIDEO3  
b.Character  
:
ABCDEFGHIJKLM  
NOPQRSTUVWXYZ  
abcdefghijklm  
nopqrstuvwxyz  
0123456789-.'  
()+*/=,:;!?_  
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
D.F. Multiplex  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for AAC  
sound multiplex broadcasting (e.g., a bilingual  
broadcast). This option can be set for Main B and Zone  
2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, Multiplex (Default),  
Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra, Unplugged, Studio-  
Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full Mono, Dolby VS,  
and Last.  
Press the [ ] button to select  
Character,and then press the [  
button to display the Character Input  
screen.  
1
]
Press the [ ]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ] buttons to  
select characters you want to enter, and  
then press the [ENTER] button.  
2
3
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, Mono, Multiplex, Dolby VS, and Last.  
Multichannel  
Repeat step 2 above to enter up to ten  
characters.  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for analog  
multichannel connection.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
If you have selected the wrong character:  
Pressing [RETURN] moves the cursor back to  
the previous character.  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, Mono, Multichannel  
(Default), THX, Mono Movie, Enhance, Orchestra,  
Unplugged, Studio-Mix, TV Logic, All Ch Stereo, Full  
Mono, Dolby VS, and Last.  
To change a character:  
1. Press the [ENTER] button (repeatedly) to  
locate the cursor on the character to be cor-  
rected.  
2. Press the [ ]/[ ] buttons to select the  
new character, and then press the [ENTER]  
button.  
If the name is shorter than ten characters, enter  
blanks to make the length of the name ten  
characters.  
176.4/192 kHz  
Here, you can specify the listening mode for playing  
audio output signals at 192 kHz and 176.4 kHz such as  
DVD-Audio. This option can be set for Main B and  
Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
You can select from the listening modes listed below:  
(Main A/B)  
Pure Audio, Direct, Stereo, and Last.  
(Zone 2)  
Direct, Stereo, and Last.  
Press the [SETUP] button.  
Setup is complete, and the menu screen  
disappears.  
4
To erase all the characters entered:  
At step 1 above, press the [ ] button instead of the  
Character Edit Sub-menu  
Character Display  
[
] button.  
Specify whether or not the name given to an input  
source should be displayed.  
No: The name given is not displayed. Only the name of  
the input source is displayed.  
Yes (Default): The name given is displayed when the  
input source is replaced.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Setup—Continued  
IntelliVolume Sub-menu  
12V Trigger Assign Sub-menu  
When multiple devices are connected to the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, the volume may vary for a  
device even when volume settings on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E are identical.  
Reducing the variance in the volume level will allow  
you to enjoy sounds at the same volume level without  
adjusting the volume control on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
When the 12V TRIGGER OUT jack on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is connected to the12V  
TRIGGER IN jack of a device, you can specify the  
room where you are going to trigger the device to turn  
on the power (for connection details, see page 46).  
The default settings are as follows:  
Room setting  
Main  
Delay  
Trigger A  
Trigger B  
Trigger C  
Trigger D  
Trigger E  
0
1
2
0
2
IntelliVolume  
Zone 2  
Zone 3  
Off  
Use the [ ] button when the volume is louder than  
other devices, and the [ ] button when the volume is  
quieter.  
Main  
You can set at 0.5 dB intervals within a range from  
12.0 dB to +12.0 dB. The default is 0.0 dB.  
Trigger A-E  
The following are settings for the 12V trigger jacks A-  
E:  
Off: Select when not using.  
Main: Select when you want to power on a connected  
device only used in the main room.  
Delay Sub-menu  
This section describes how to adjust the delay of  
sounds.  
Zone 2: Select when you want to power on a connected  
device only used in Zone 2.  
Zone 3: Select when you want to power on a connected  
device only used in Zone 3.  
Main/Zone 2: Select when you want to power on a  
connected device only used in the main room or Zone 2.  
Main/Zone 3: Select when you want to power on a  
connected device only used in the main room or Zone 3.  
Zone 2/Zone 3: Select when you want to power on a  
connected device only used in Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
Main/Zone 2/Zone 3: Select when you want to power  
on a connected device used in any area: main room,  
Zone 2, or Zone 3.  
A/V Sync  
When the picture is not synchronized with the sound,  
you can synchronize them using these settings. This  
option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as for  
Main A.  
You can set at 0.1 ms intervals within a range from 0.0  
ms to 300.0 ms.  
Relative Delay - Center, Surr L/R, Surr Back  
Our proprietary Enhanced Special Positioning  
Algorithm(an extended three-dimensional positioning  
algorithm) ne tunes the sound eld. This algorithm is  
able to create a maximum delay of 10 ms in the output  
of each speaker. This delay is equivalent to a distance of  
about 3 meters between speakers. This option can be set  
for both Main A and Main B.  
When Centeris set to Not Usedon the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, there is no setting for  
Center.Likewise, if Surr L/Ris set to Not  
Used,or Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,” “Bi-  
Amp for Front,or Not Used,there is also no  
setting for corresponding speakers.  
You can set at 0.1 ms intervals within a range from  
10.0 ms to +10.0 ms. The default is 0.0 ms.  
Use this function to ne tune your surround  
environment after setting the distance between speakers  
(See page 89) and the volume level (See page 90).  
Extending the distance between speakers (widening the  
delay in time) will expand the sound eld, while  
reducing the distance (narrowing the delay) will make  
the sound eld sharper.  
A delay-E delay  
When a 12V trigger-connected device is powered on, a  
large amount of current may, depending on the device  
type, ow instantaneously. To ease the effects of this  
problem, you can set time interval differences for output  
signals from the 12V Trigger.  
Setting time interval differences may prevent  
unnecessary noise (bubbling sounds).  
0 sec: Select when not setting any difference.  
1 sec: Select when setting output signals 1 second after  
power on to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
2 sec: Select when setting output signals 2 seconds after  
power on to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
3 sec: Select when setting output signals 3 seconds after  
power on to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup  
This menu allows you to congure the listening mode  
settings including audio effect and playback options.  
When the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the available options will be Center A,”  
Center B,” “Center A+B,and Front L/R A.”  
When the (Speaker A) Centeris set to Not Usedin  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Front L/R A,” “Front L/R B,and  
Front L/R A+B.In this case, the default setting is  
Front L/R A.”  
Mono Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
Mono listening mode.  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
When the (Speaker B) Centeris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the available options will be Center A,”  
Front L/R A,” “Front L/R B,and Front L/R A+B.”  
When the impedance setting for either Front L/R A”  
or Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu  
is set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,” “Front L/R A+B”  
cannot be selected. Similarly, when the impedance  
setting for either Center Aor Center Bin the  
Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to 6 ohmsor 4  
ohms,” “Center A+Bcannot be selected.  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
or Academy effect is applied or not. Use these effects  
when you do not want to overemphasize the treble  
sound. This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Off (Default): The effects are not applied.  
Re-EQ On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble  
is overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
Academy On: Lowers the treble level and lters the  
noise when the source contains emphasized treble  
sound and too much hiss, such as an old mono audio  
movie recorded onto videotape.  
When the (Speaker A) Centeris set to Not Used”  
and the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, this setting will not be displayed.  
b. Input Channel  
This option congures the output method when you  
play the stereo input source in the Mono listening mode.  
This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Auto L+R (Default) : The same audio signals are  
output from the left and right speakers.  
Left: When you play an input source with different  
languages recorded on each channel, the left channel is  
output from the left and right speakers.  
Right: When you play an input source where different  
languages are recorded on each channel, the right  
channel is output from the left and right speakers.  
d. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when playing  
the source in the Mono listening mode. Select the terminal to  
which the subwoofer you want to use is connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker A) Subwooferis  
set to an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu. However, when the (Speaker B)  
Subwooferis set to an option other than Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available options will  
be Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
c. Output Speaker  
This option congures the speakers to use when playing  
the source in the Mono listening mode. Select the  
speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to use  
are connected.  
Center A (Default) : Outputs the source only from the  
speaker connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A  
terminal.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
Center B: Outputs the source only from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
Center A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Front L/R A: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
Front L/R B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Front L/R A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and  
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this  
option is not available when the front speakers are in Bi-  
amp or in BTL conguration.  
Multiplex Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
D.F. Multiplex listening mode.  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
or Academy effect is applied or not. Use these effects  
when you do not want to overemphasize the treble  
sound. This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Off (Default): The effects are not applied.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
Re-EQ On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble  
is overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
Academy On: Lowers the treble level and lters the  
noise when the source contains emphasized treble  
sound and too much hiss, such as an old mono audio  
movie recorded onto videotape.  
cannot be selected. Similarly, when the impedance  
setting for either Center Aor Center Bin the  
Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to 6 ohmsor 4  
ohms,” “Center A+Bcannot be selected.  
When the (Speaker A) Centeris set to Not Used”  
and the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, this setting will not be displayed.  
b. Multiplex Input Channel  
d. Subwoofer  
This option allows you to select the preferred audio  
channel when the input is the AAC/Dolby Digital sound  
multiplex signal. This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
The input channel setting made here will be applied to  
all the listening modes for the Dolby Digital and AAC  
input signal 1+1sources.  
Main (Default): The main channel is preferred for  
output.  
Sub: The sub-channel is preferred for output.  
Main+Sub: The main and sub-channel are output.  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the D.F. Multiplex listening mode.  
Select the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to  
use is connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
c. Output Speaker  
This option congures the speakers to use when playing  
the source in the D.F. Multiplex listening mode. Select  
the speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to  
use are connected.  
Center A: Outputs the source only from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
Center B: Outputs the source only from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
Center A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback  
Stereo Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
Stereo listening mode.  
Front L/R A (Default): Outputs the source from the  
speakers connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
Front L/R B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Front L/R A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and  
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this  
option is not available when the front speakers are in Bi-  
amp or in BTL conguration.  
When the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the available options will be Center A,”  
Center B,” “Center A+B,and Front L/R A.”  
When the (Speaker A) Centeris set to Not Usedin  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Front L/R A,” “Front L/R B,and  
Front L/R A+B.In this case, the default setting is  
Front L/R A.”  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
or Academy effect is applied or not in the Stereo  
listening mode. Use these effects when you do not want  
to overemphasize the treble sound. This option can also  
be set for Zone 2.  
Off (Default): The effects are not applied.  
Re-EQ On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble  
is overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
Academy On: Lowers the treble level and lters the  
noise when the source contains emphasized treble  
sound and too much hiss, such as an old mono audio  
movie recorded onto videotape.  
b. Front Speaker  
When the (Speaker B) Centeris set to an option  
other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the available options will be Center A,”  
Front L/R A,” “Front L/R B,and Front L/R A+B.”  
When the impedance setting for either Front L/R A”  
or Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu  
is set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,” “Front L/R A+B”  
This option congures the speakers to use when playing  
the source in the Stereo listening mode. Select the  
speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to use  
are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
b. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source in the Direct or Pure Audio listening  
mode. Select the speaker terminal to which the speaker  
you want to use is connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
c. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the Stereo listening mode. Select  
the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
c. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source in the Direct or Pure Audio  
listening mode. Select the speaker terminals to which  
the speakers you want to use are connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Direct, Pure Audio Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
Direct or Pure Audio listening mode.  
a. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source in the Direct or Pure Audio listening  
mode. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
d. Surr Bk Speaker  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source in the Direct or Pure Audio  
listening mode. Select the speaker terminals to which  
the speakers you want to use are connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,”  
this setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
PL IIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Off: Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
b. Re-EQ  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not when playing an analog  
multichannel source such as DVD-Audio and Super  
Audio CD. Use this effect when you do not want to  
overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
e. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the Direct or Pure Audio listening  
mode. Select the terminal to which the subwoofer you  
want to use is connected. This setting can be made when  
the (Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other  
than Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to an  
option other than Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, the available options will be Aor Not  
Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
c. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays an analog multi  
channel source such as DVD-Audio and Super Audio  
CD. Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers  
you want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
Multichannel Input Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play an analog  
multichannel source such as DVD-Audio and Super  
Audio CD.  
a. SB Mode (5ch)  
This option selects the enhancement mode for playback  
when you play a 5.1ch analog multichannel source as a  
6.1 or higher channel source through the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. The surround back setting you select here  
will be applied to all of the multichannel input signals.  
This option will not appear when the Surr Back  
Channel setting in the Audio Assign sub-menu is set  
to SBL/SBR (7.1ch).”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, this option will not be  
displayed.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PL IIx Movie (Default): Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1  
or higher channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Movie mode.  
d. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays an analog  
multichannel source such as DVD-Audio and Super  
Audio CD. Select the speaker terminal to which the  
speaker you want to use is connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to Main  
Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
g. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays an input source such  
as DVD-Audio and Super Audio CD. Select the  
terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
e. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays an input  
source such as DVD-Audio and SuperAudio CD. Select  
the speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to  
use are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio Input  
Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play DVD-Audio that is  
input from the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface.  
f. Surr Bk Speaker  
a. LFE Level  
This option congures the surround back speakers to use  
when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays an input  
source such as DVD-Audio and Super Audio CD. Select  
the speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to  
use are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Surr Backis set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu. However, when the  
(Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,” “Bi-  
Amp for Front,or Not Used,this setting will not be  
displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option allows you to set the bass level for the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio listening mode. The  
LFE level setting made here will be applied to all of the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio input signals. The  
available settings are dB, 20 dB, 10 dB, and 0 dB.  
The option defaults to 0.”  
b. SB Mode (5ch)  
Selects the enhancement mode for playback when you  
play a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel source  
through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The surround  
back setting you select here will be applied to the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio input signal */2.”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, this option will not  
be displayed.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PLIIx Movie: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie  
mode.  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Audio. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
Off (Default): Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
c. Re-EQ  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
d. Front Speaker  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays DVD-  
Audio. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,”  
this setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays DVD-Audio.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
e. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays DVD-Audio.  
Select the speaker terminal to which the speaker you  
want to use is connected. This setting can be made when  
the (Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
h. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays DVD-Audio. Select  
the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays DVD-  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
you want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD Input Setup  
Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a Super Audio CD  
input from the i.LINK (AUDIO) interface.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
a. LFE Level  
This option allows you to set the bass level for the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD listening mode. The LFE  
level setting made here will be applied to all of the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD input signals. The available  
settings are dB, 20 dB, 10 dB, and 0 dB. The  
option defaults to 0.”  
e. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a Super Audio  
CD. Select the speaker terminal to which the speaker  
you want to use is connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
b. SB Mode (5ch)  
Selects the enhancement mode for playback when you  
play a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel source  
through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The surround  
back setting you select here will be applied to the  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD input signal */2.”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, this option will not  
be displayed.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PLIIx Movie: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie  
mode.  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Off (Default): Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a Super  
Audio CD. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
c. Re-EQ  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
d. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a Super Audio  
CD. Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
The available settings are dB, 20 dB, 10 dB, and 0  
dB. The option defaults to 0.This option can also be  
set for Zone 2.  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a Super  
Audio CD. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,”  
this setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
b. Late Night  
This option allows you to set how the Late Night  
function works (See page 55). The setting you select  
here will be applied to all of the Dolby Digital input  
signals. Note that the Late Night setting will not be  
retained and will return to Offafter the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E enters the standby state. This option can  
also be set for Zone 2.  
Off: Disables the Late Night function.  
Low: Narrows the volume range.  
High: Narrows the volume range more than the Low”  
setting.  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
c. Dolby EX  
This option congures the Dolby EX effect when  
playing the source in the Dolby Digital listening mode.  
Auto: Automatically plays a source using the Dolby EX  
mode when the source contains the Dolby Digital EX  
identication signal. When this signal is not contained,  
the setting of SB Mode (5ch)is applied.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Manual: The setting of SB Mode (5ch)is applied  
regardless of the Dolby Digital EX identication signal.  
d. SB Mode (5ch)  
h. Subwoofer  
This option allows you to select the enhancement mode  
for playback when you play a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or  
higher channel source through the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. The surround back setting you select here  
will be applied to the Dolby Digital input signal */2.”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, this option will not  
be displayed.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PLIIx Movie (Default): Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1  
or higher channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Movie mode.  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a Super Audio CD.  
Select the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to  
use is connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Off: Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
Dolby Digital Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
Dolby Digital listening mode.  
e. Re-EQ  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
a. LFE Level  
This option allows you to set the bass level for the Dolby  
Digital listening mode. The LFE level setting made here  
will be applied to all of the Dolby Digital input signals.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
f. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Digital listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
i. Surr Bk Speaker  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source in the Dolby Digital  
listening mode. Select the speaker terminals to which  
the speakers you want to use are connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,”  
this setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
g. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Digital listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminal to which the speaker you  
want to use is connected. This setting can be made when  
the (Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
j. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Digital listening mode.  
Select the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to  
use is connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
h. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source in the Dolby Digital listening  
mode. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
DTS Setup Sub-menu  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
DTS listening mode.  
a. LFE Level  
This option allows you to set the bass level for the DTS  
listening mode. The LFE level setting made here will be  
applied to all of the DTS input signals. The available  
settings are dB, 20 dB, 10 dB, and 0 dB. The  
option defaults to 0.This option can also be set for  
Zone 2.  
e. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source in the DTS listening mode. Select the  
speaker terminal to which the speaker you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the (Speaker B)  
Centeris set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
b. SB Mode (5ch)  
This option allows you to select the enhancement mode  
for playback when you play a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or  
higher channel source through the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. The surround back setting you select  
here will be applied to the DTS input signal */2.”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, this option will not  
be displayed.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PLIIx Movie: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie  
mode.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source in the DTS listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Off: Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
c. Re-EQ  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
d. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source in the DTS listening mode. Select the  
speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to use  
are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
settings are dB, 20 dB, 10 dB, and 0 dB. The option  
defaults to 0.This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source in the DTS listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu. However, when  
the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,”  
Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,this setting will not  
be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
b. SB Mode (5ch)  
Selects the enhancement mode for playback when you  
play a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel source  
through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The surround  
back setting you select here will be applied to the AAC  
input signal */2.”  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu, this option will not  
be displayed.  
Dolby EX: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Digital EX mode.  
PLIIx Movie (Default): Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1  
or higher channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Movie mode.  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu differ, the available options  
will be Aand B.”  
When you set the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting to  
Main A 1ch (SBL)in the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu, you cannot select PLIIx Movie.”  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
NEO:6: Plays a 5.1ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel  
source using the DTS NEO:6 mode.  
Off: Plays an original 5.1ch source as it is.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
h. Subwoofer  
c. Re-EQ  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the DTS listening mode. Select the  
terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
d. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source in the AAC listening mode. Select  
the speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to  
use are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
AAC Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
AAC listening mode.  
a. LFE Level  
This option allows you to set the bass level for the AAC  
listening mode. The LFE level setting made here will be  
applied to all of the AAC input signals. The available  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
e. Center Speaker  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source in the AAC listening mode. Select  
the speaker terminal to which the speaker you want to  
use is connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
h. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the AAC listening mode. Select  
the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source in the AAC listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx/DTS NEO:6 (2ch  
Input only) Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a 2ch input source  
in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx or DTS NEO:6 listening  
modes. This setting can be made when the (Speaker A)  
Centeror (Speaker A) Surr Backsetting is set to an  
option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for  
Front,” “Bi-Amp for Frontor Not Used,the PLII  
mode will be used instead of the PLIIx mode.  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source in the AAC listening mode.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu. However, when  
the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,”  
Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,this setting will not  
be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
a. Surr Mode (2ch)  
Selects the enhancement mode for playback when you  
play a 2ch source as a 6.1 or higher channel source  
through the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. The surround  
mode setting you select here will be applied to the  
Analog/PCM and D.F. 2ch input signals.  
The option NEO:6 Musicwill be available when the  
(SpeakerA) Surr Back setting is set to MainAin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
PLIIx Movie (Default): Plays a 2ch source as a 6.1 or  
higher channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Movie mode.  
PLIIx Music: Plays a 2ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music  
mode.  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu differ, the available options  
will be Aand B.”  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
PLIIx Game: Plays a 2ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game  
mode.  
NEO:6 Cinema: Plays a 2ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the DTS NEO:6NEO:6 Cinema  
mode.  
image. The available settings for this option are  
between 0and 5.The default value is 2.”  
f. Re-EQ  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
effect is applied or not. Use this effect when you do not  
want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effect is not applied.  
On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble is  
overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
NEO:6 Music: Plays a 2ch source as a 6.1 or higher  
channel source using the DTS NEO:6 Music mode.  
b. PLIIx Music Panorama  
This option allows you to congure the panorama effect  
during the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode. This effect  
will expand the sound space horizontally.  
g. Front Speaker  
On: The panorama effect is turned on.  
Off (Default): The panorama effect is turned off.  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx or DTS  
NEO:6 listening modes. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Front L/R”  
is set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-  
menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
c. PLIIx Music Dimension  
This option allows you to change the entire sound space  
location either forward or backward during the Dolby  
Pro Logic IIx Music mode. The option defaults to 3.”  
The value 3locates the sound space to the center  
position. If you select values between 2and 0,the  
sound space moves forward. If you select values  
between 4and 6,the sound space moves backward.  
Tips:  
When you feel the sound space is too expanded or that  
there is too much surround effect, move the sound space  
forward to obtain a better balance. When you feel the  
sound space is just like a mono source or is too narrow,  
move the sound space backward to obtain a better balance.  
d. PLIIx Music Center Width  
This option allows you to adjust the sound image width  
which the center speaker covers during the Dolby Pro  
Logic IIx Music mode. When you play the source in the  
Dolby Pro Logic II mode and the center speaker is  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, the center  
channel signal is output only from the center speaker (if  
the center speaker is not connected, the center channel  
signal will be equally divided into the left and right front  
speakers to create a virtual center sound image). In this  
option, adjust the output balance between the center and  
front left/right speakers to determine the scale for the  
central sound image. The available settings for this  
option are between 0and 7.The default value is 3.”  
h. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx or DTS  
NEO:6 listening modes. Select the speaker terminal to  
which the speaker you want to use is connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Centeris  
set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
e. NEO:6 Music Center Image  
This setting can be made when the (Speaker A) Surr  
Back setting is set to Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
The DTS NEO:6 Music mode is a listening mode in  
which an original 2ch source is played as a 6ch source.  
In this mode, the signal for center channel will be  
created from the signals deducted to some extent from  
the left and right front channels. This option allows you  
to congure how much the signals are deducted from  
the left and right channels to produce the center channel  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
i. Surr L/R Sp  
in the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx or  
DTS NEO:6 listening modes. Select the speaker  
terminals to which the speakers you want to use are  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting fo Surr L/R Aor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
THX Setup Sub-menu  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you apply the THX effect in  
the THX mode. The settings in this sub-menu can be  
made when the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting is set to  
an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
j. Surr Bk Speaker  
a. Surround EX  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
or DTS NEO:6 listening modes. Select the speaker  
terminals to which the speakers you want to use are  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Surr Backis set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu. However, when the  
(Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,” “Bi-  
Amp for Front,or Not Used,this setting will not be  
displayed.  
This option congures the Surround EX effect.  
Auto: Automatically plays a source using the Surround  
EX mode when the source contains the Dolby Digital  
EX identication signal. When the Dolby Digital EX  
identication signal is not contained and the signal is  
from the multichannel source, the setting of SB Mode  
(5ch)is applied. When the signal is from the 2ch-  
source, the setting of SB Mode (2ch)is applied.  
Manual: The setting of SB Mode (5ch)is applied  
when the signal is from the multichannel source,  
regardless of the Dolby Digital EX identication signal.  
When the signal is from the 2ch source, the setting of  
SB Mode (2ch)is applied.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
b.THX Mode (5ch)  
This option allows you to select which THX mode the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will use when applying the  
THX effect to the signal. The THX Mode you select  
here will be given preference over the SB Mode (5ch).  
When the (Speaker A) Surr Back setting is Main A  
1chin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the  
available options will be THX Cinemaand  
SurroundEX.”  
THX Cinema: This mode is suitable for theater movies  
that are recorded and edited so that they are optimized  
for playing in a large space such as a movie theater.  
SurroundEX: The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
automatically enters the THX Surround EX playback  
mode.  
Ultra2 Cinema (Default): In this new mode for the  
THX Ultra2, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays  
5.1ch music or movie as a 7.1 or higher channel source.  
Music Mode: This new mode for the THX Ultra2 is  
suitable for a music source. In this mode, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a 5.1ch music source  
as a 7.1 or higher channel source.  
k. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source in the Dolby Pro Logic IIx or DTS  
NEO:6 listening modes. Select the terminal to which  
the subwoofer you want to use is connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker A) Subwoofer”  
is set to an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu. However, when the (Speaker  
B) Subwooferis set to an option other than Main A”  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
Games Mode: In this new mode for the THX Ultra2,  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays 5.1ch game  
source as a 7.1 or higher channel source.  
Select the speaker terminals to which the speakers you  
want to use are connected. This setting can be made  
when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris set to Main Ain  
the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
c.THX Mode (2ch)  
This option allows you to select which THX mode the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will use when applying the  
THX effect to the signal.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
THX Cinema: This mode is suitable for theater movies  
that are recorded and edited so that they are optimized  
for playing in a large space such as a movie theater.  
Games Mode: In this new mode for the THX Ultra2,  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E plays a 2 ch game  
source as a 7.1 or higher channel source.  
d. Front Speaker  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source with the THX effect applied. Select  
the speaker terminals to which the speakers you want to  
use are connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source with the THX effect  
applied. Select the speaker terminals to which the  
speakers you want to use are connected. This setting can  
be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,”  
this setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp on in  
BTL conguration.  
e. Center Speaker  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source with the THX effect applied. Select  
the speaker terminal to which the speaker you want to  
use is connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Centeris set to Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
h. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source with the THX effect applied. Select  
the terminal to which the subwoofer you want to use is  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker A) Subwooferis set to an option other than  
Not Usedin the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker B) Subwooferis set to  
an option other than Main Ain the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, the available options will be  
Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source with the THX effect applied.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
e. Center Speaker  
Mono Movie Setup/Enhance Setup/  
Orchestra Setup/Unplugged Setup/  
Studio-Mix Setup/TV Logic Setup  
Sub-menu  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminal to which  
the speaker you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the  
Onkyo original listening mode. The settings in this sub-  
menu can be made when the (Speaker A) Surr L/R  
setting is set to an option other than Not Usedin the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
a. Front Effect  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option allows you to turn off the reverb for the  
front speakers. This is useful when playing live material  
that already contains live reverberation as the added  
reverb simply blurs the original sound. When the Front  
Effect is turned off, no reverb is added to the front left,  
front right, and center speakers and the original  
reverberation can be heard as it is.  
On (Default): The Front Effect is turned on and the  
reverb is added.  
Off: The Front Effect is turned off.  
f. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris  
set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
b. Reverb Level  
This option allows you to adjust the amount of reverb to  
suit your listening environment, source material, and so  
on. The available settings are Small, Mid, and Large.  
The option defaults to Mid.”  
c. Reverb Time  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This option allows you to adjust the reverb time to suit  
your listening environment, source material, and so on.  
The available settings are Short, Mid, and Long. The  
option defaults to Mid.”  
g. Surr Bk Speaker  
d. Front Speaker  
This option congures the surround back speakers to use  
when playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr Backis  
set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
However, when the (Speaker A) Surr Backis set to  
BTL for Front,” “Bi-Amp for Front,or Not Used,this  
setting will not be displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Front L/R”  
is set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-  
menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
b. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to which  
the speakers you want to use are connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Front L/Ris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
h. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source. Select the terminal to which the  
subwoofer you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker A) Subwooferis set  
to an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu. However, when the (Speaker  
B) Subwooferis set to an option other than Main A”  
in the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Aor Not Used.”  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
c. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminal to which  
the speaker you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
All Ch Stereo Setup/Full Mono Setup  
Sub-menu  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the audio effect  
and playback options when you play a source in the All  
Ch Stereo or Full Mono listening modes. The settings in  
this sub-menu can be made when the (Speaker A)  
Center setting is set to an option other than Not Used”  
in the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
d. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris  
set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
a. Re-EQ/Academy  
This option allows you to congure whether the Re-EQ  
or Academy effect is applied or not in the Onkyo  
original listening mode. Use these effects when you do  
not want to overemphasize the treble sound.  
Off (Default): The effects are not applied.  
Re-EQ On: Adjusts the soundtrack in which the treble  
is overemphasized, so that the sound is optimized for  
home theater.  
Academy On: Lowers the treble level and lters the  
noise when the source contains emphasized treble  
sound and too much hiss, such as an old mono audio  
movie recorded onto videotape.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
e. Surr Bk Speaker  
Reference (Default): The general 5.1ch surround  
sound is simulated.  
This option congures the surround back speakers to  
use when playing the source. Select the speaker  
terminals to which the speakers you want to use are  
connected. This setting can be made when the  
(Speaker B) Surr Backis set to Main Ain the  
Speaker Conguration sub-menu. However, when the  
(Speaker A) Surr Backis set to BTL for Front,” “Bi-  
Amp for Front,or Not Used,this setting will not be  
displayed.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
b. Front Speaker  
This option congures the front speakers to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Front L/R”  
is set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-  
menu.  
When the impedance setting for Front L/R Aor  
Front L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is  
set to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will  
be Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS A and FRONT L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals. Note that this option is not  
available when the front speakers are in Bi-amp or in  
BTL conguration.  
When the settings for (Speaker A) Surr Backand  
(Speaker B) Surr Backin the Speaker Conguration  
sub-menu differ, the available options will be Aand  
B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A  
terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR BACK L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR  
BACK L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
c. Center Speaker  
This option congures the center speaker to use when  
playing the source. Select the speaker terminal to which  
the speaker you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker B) Centeris set to  
Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Center Aor  
Center Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set  
to 6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speaker  
connected to the CENTER SPEAKERS A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source from the speaker connected to the  
CENTER SPEAKERS B terminal.  
f. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source. Select the terminal to which the  
subwoofer you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker A) Subwooferis set  
to an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu. However, when the (Speaker  
B) Subwooferis set to an option other than Main A”  
in the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the CENTER SPEAKERS A and CENTER  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
d. Surr L/R Sp  
This option congures the surround speakers to use  
when playing the source. Select the speaker terminals to  
which the speakers you want to use are connected. This  
setting can be made when the (Speaker B) Surr L/Ris  
set to Main Ain the Speaker Conguration sub-menu.  
When the impedance setting for Surr L/RAor Surr  
L/R Bin the Speaker Impedance sub-menu is set to  
6 ohmsor 4 ohms,the available options will be  
Aand B.”  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
Dolby Virtual Speaker Setup Sub-  
menu  
This sub-menu allows you to congure the playback  
options when you use the Dolby Virtual Speaker effect.  
A (Default): Outputs the source from the speakers  
connected to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A terminals.  
B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected to  
the SURR L/R SPEAKERS B terminals.  
a. Mode (2ch or 3ch only)  
This option allows you to congure the width of a virtual  
sound image which is simulated using two or three  
speakers while you use the Dolby Virtual Speaker effect.  
Wide: The breadth of the sound image is emphasized.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening Mode Setup—Continued  
A+B: Outputs the source from the speakers connected  
to the SURR L/R SPEAKERS A and SURR L/R  
SPEAKERS B terminals.  
e. Subwoofer  
This option congures the subwoofer to use when  
playing the source. Select the terminal to which the  
subwoofer you want to use is connected. This setting  
can be made when the (Speaker A) Subwooferis set  
to an option other than Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu. However, when the (Speaker  
B) Subwooferis set to an option other than Main A”  
in the Speaker Conguration sub-menu, the available  
options will be Aor Not Used.”  
A (Default): Outputs the source only from the  
subwoofer connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  
A terminal.  
B: Outputs the source only from the subwoofer  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminal.  
A+B: Outputs the source from the subwoofers  
connected to the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT A and  
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT B terminals.  
Not Used: No subwoofers are used for playback.  
In Zone 2, you can set the following options.  
a. Mode  
This option allows you to congure the width of a  
virtual sound image which is simulated using two  
speakers while you use the Dolby Virtual Speaker  
effect.  
Wide: The breadth of the sound image is emphasized.  
Reference (Default): The general 5.1 ch suround sound  
is simulated.  
b. Decode (2 ch)  
This option allows you to select the decode mode before  
the Dolby Virtual Speaker effect is applied.  
Dolby Pro Logic II: The Dolby Virtual Speaker effect  
is applied after the signal is decoded with Dolby Pro  
Logic II.  
DTS NEO:6: The Dolby Virtual Speaker effect is  
applied after the signal is decoded with DTS NEO:6.  
Dolby Headphone Setup Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to enable/disable the Dolby  
Headphone function when you use the headphones.  
a. Mode  
On (Defalt): Enables the Dolby Headphone function.  
Off: Disables the Dolby Headphon function.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio Adjust  
Surr Bk Bass  
Tone Control Sub-menu  
Option for adjusting bass notes from the surround back  
speaker. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12  
dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
If Surr Backis set to BTL for Frontor Bi-Amp  
for Fronton the Speaker Conguration sub-menu,  
this item is not displayed.  
You can adjust bass, mid, and treble notes for each  
speaker set.  
For any speaker set to Not Usedin the Speaker  
Conguration sub-menu, no associated setting item is  
displayed.  
Front Bass  
Surr Bk Mid  
Option for adjusting bass notes from front L/R  
speakers. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Option for adjusting mid notes from the surround back  
speaker. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12  
dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
If Surr Backis set to BTL for Frontand Bi-Amp  
for Fronton the Speaker Conguration sub-menu,  
this item is not displayed.  
This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Front Mid  
Option for adjusting mid notes from front L/R speakers.  
Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12 dB to  
+12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Surr Bk Treble  
Option for adjusting treble notes from the surround  
back speaker. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
If Surr Backis set to BTL for Frontor Bi-Amp  
for Fronton the Speaker Conguration sub-menu,  
this item is not displayed.  
This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Front Treble  
Option for adjusting treble notes from front L/R  
speakers. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Subwoofer Bass  
This option can also be set for Zone 2.  
Option for adjusting bass notes from the subwoofer.  
Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12 dB to  
+12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Center Bass  
Option for adjusting bass notes from the center speaker.  
Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12 dB to  
+12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Center Mid  
Option for adjusting mid notes from the center speaker.  
Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from 12 dB to  
+12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Center Treble  
Option for adjusting treble notes from the center  
speaker. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Surr L/R Bass  
Option for adjusting bass notes from surround L/R  
speakers. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Surr L/R Mid  
Option for adjusting mid notes from surround L/R  
speakers. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
Surr L/R Treble  
Option for adjusting treble notes from surround L/R  
speakers. Specify at 1 dB intervals in a range from  
12 dB to +12 dB. The default is 0.”  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preferences  
This menu allows you to congure the listening mode settings including audio effects and playback options.  
video terminal. This option can be set for both Main A  
and Main B.  
Volume Setup Sub-menu  
OSD On (Default): OSD is displayed.  
OSD Off: OSD is not displayed.  
a. Volume Display  
You can switch the volume indication between an  
absolute value and a relative value.  
b. Immediate Display  
Absolute (absolute value): Displayed in a range from 0  
to 100.  
Relative (relative value) (Default): Displayed in a  
range of dB, 81.5 dB, 80 dB......18.0 dB. An  
absolute volume value of 82 is equivalent to a relative  
volume value of 0 dB.  
Specify whether or not to display the description of  
operations on the screen while you are operating the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E (when the component video  
signal is output, nothing is displayed if set to On). This  
option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as for  
Main A.  
On (Default): Displayed.  
Off: Not displayed.  
b. Muting Level  
You can adjust the volume level of muted sounds.  
Specify at 10 dB intervals in a range from dB and –  
50 dB to 10 dB. The default is “–.”  
c. Display Position  
Specify the position where the Immediate Display  
should be displayed. You can set in a range of ten  
positions from Top to Bottom of the screen. By default,  
it is displayed at the Bottom of the screen. This option  
can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
This option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as  
for Main A.  
c. Maximum Volume  
You can set the maximum output volume level to  
prevent sounds from becoming too loud. When  
displaying in absolute values, specify at 0.5 intervals in  
a range from 50.0 to 99.5. When displaying in relative  
values, specify at 0.5 dB intervals in a range from 32  
dB to +17.5 dB. If you do not want to set any specic  
value, leave this item Off,the default setting.  
This option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as  
for Main A.  
d. Scan Mode  
Specify whether or not to output the video signal with  
interlace mode.  
Interlaced: Outputs with interlace mode.  
NonInterlaced: Does not output with interlace mode.  
e. Net-Tune OSD Display  
Specify whether or not to display a description of  
operations on the screen when using Net-Tune (when  
the component video signal is output, nothing is  
displayed if set to On). This option can be set for Main  
B and Zone 2 as well as for Main A.  
d. Power On Volume  
You can set a constant volume level of sounds output  
when the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is powered on.  
When displaying in absolute values, specify at 0.5  
intervals in a range from 0 to 100. When displaying in  
relative values, specify at 0.5 dB intervals in a range  
from dB and 81.5 dB to +18 dB (Max). If you want  
to maintain a selected volume level setting when putting  
the apparatus into standby status, select Last.”  
This option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as well as  
for Main A.  
On (Default): Displayed.  
Off: Not displayed.  
OSD Position Sub-menu  
This sub-menu allows you to adjust the position of the  
OSD Setup Menu as it is displayed on your screen.  
Depending on the monitor used, there may be cases  
where the OSD Setup Menu is not displayed in the  
center and parts of the menus are cut off. To adjust the  
position of the OSD Setup Menu, simply press the  
cursor buttons to inch the menu to the position you  
desire. This option can be set for Main B and Zone 2 as  
well as for Main A.  
Headphone Level Setup Sub-menu  
a. Headphone Level  
When the volume level differs between speakers and  
headphones, you can, in advance, ne tune the  
headphones volume. Adjust at 0.5 dB intervals in a  
range from 12 dB to +12 dB.  
OSD Setup Sub-menu  
a. Component Video  
Specify whether or not to display the On Screen Display  
(OSD) on the TV screen connected to the component  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i.LINK Setup  
This menu can be used when connecting to an Onkyo i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready device.  
enabled, audio signals of SACD will be output through  
Wakeup Setup  
i.LINK when no source is selected for Zone 2, or it will  
be output in analog format when any source is selected  
for Zone 2.  
Enable: Enables the DVD Output for Zone 2 function.  
Disable (Default): Disables the DVD Output for Zone  
2 function.  
a. Wakeup on i.LINK (IEEE1394)  
Specify connecting condition on standby of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Enable: To be left connected.  
Disable (Default): To be disconnected while the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is on standby to save  
electricity.  
OSD for DVD  
a. OSD for DVD  
Even when a DVD player is directly connected to the  
TV, the OSD screen of the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
can be displayed on the TV monitor if the DVD player  
is an Onkyo i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready device. In this  
case, use the i.LINK cable to connect the i.LINK  
(AUDIO) terminal on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
and i.LINK (AUDIO) terminal on the DVD player.  
Disable (Default): Select this to block OSD screen  
display.  
Left: Select this to display the OSD screen on the left  
side of the TV monitor.  
Right: Select this to display the OSD screen on the  
right side of the TV monitor.  
b. Select DVD  
Select the name of the device that should display the  
OSD screen using the [ ]/[ ] cursor buttons if  
multiple Onkyo i.LINK (AUDIO)-ready devices are  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. This item  
does not appear when Disableis selected in the OSD  
for DVD setting.  
Select Nowhen you do not want to select any device.  
OSD for DVD (Zone 2)  
When listening in Zone 2, the same setting as above is  
available.  
DVD Output Synchro  
a. i.LINK Selector Change  
This menu allows you to enable/disable the i.LINK  
Selector Change function. When an i.LINK (AUDIO)-  
enable device is used to playback, this function switches  
the input source to the one assigned to the device.  
Enable: Enables the i.LINK Selector Change function.  
Disable (Default): Disables the i.LINK Selector  
Change function.  
b. DVD Output for Zone 2  
This option automatically switches the i.LINK Audio  
Output of Onkyos DVD players. With this function  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Setup  
If using a broadband router (DHCP function), you need not perform 7. Network Setupbecause the DHCP function  
on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is defaulted to Enable.When the DHCP function for the broadband router is set to  
Disable,network setup is required. In this case, you have to be knowledgeable about the network.  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) andAuto IP are the mechanisms that automatically perform network  
settings such as IP address on a network device such as the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, a PC, and a broadband router.  
DNS (Domain Name System) is the mechanism that converts a domain name, such as www.onkyo.com/jp/used to  
browse a homepage, to an IP address such as 210.199.170.69used in actual communications.  
IP Address Sub-menu  
Proxy Sub-menu  
Specify when connecting to the Internet via a proxy  
server.  
a. DHCP Settings  
Specify whether or not to set DHCP automatically.  
Enable (Default): Enables the DHCP function.  
Disable: Disables the DHCP function.  
a. Proxy Server  
Some ISPs (Internet service providers) use a proxy  
server to connect to the Internet. In this case, follow the  
written instructions from the provider to set the proxy.  
Enable: Enables the proxy server function.  
b. IP Address  
Specify if Disableis selected in a. DHCP Settings.”  
When an xDSL modem or a terminal adapter is  
connected directly to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
enter the IP address provided by your ISP. The IP  
address to be entered must be in the following format.  
You cannot use the net audio function with an IP  
address that is not in the following format.  
Disable (Default): Disables the proxy server function.  
b. Proxy URL Input  
Enter the domain name of the proxy server. When  
Disableis set for a. Proxy Server,selecting this  
item and pressing the [ENTER] button will put the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E into the character entry  
mode. Press the [ ]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ] buttons to select  
numerics, and then press the [ENTER] button. When all  
numerics are entered, exit from the character entry  
mode.  
CLASS A: 10.0.0.010.255.255.255  
CLASS B: 172.16.0.0172.31.255.255  
CLASS C: 192.168.0.0192.168.255.255  
c. SUBNET Mask  
Specify if Disableis selected in a. DHCP Settings.”  
When an xDSL modem or a terminal adapter is  
connected directly to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
enter the subnet mask provided by your ISP. The subnet  
mask is usually 255.255.255.0.”  
c. Proxy Port  
Enter the port No. of the proxy server. When Disable”  
is set for a. Proxy Server,selecting this item and  
pressing the [ENTER] button will put the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E into the character entry mode. Press the  
d. Gateway  
[
]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ] buttons to select numerics, and then  
Specify if Disableis selected in a. DHCP Settings.”  
When an xDSL modem or a terminal adapter is  
connected directly to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
enter the gateway address provided by your ISP.  
press the [ENTER] button. When all numerics are  
entered, exit from the character entry mode.  
Note:  
When the settings are complete, press the [RETURN]  
button to return to the Network Setup menu. Use the  
e. DNS Server 1, DNS Server 2  
Specify if Disableis selected in a. DHCP Settings.”  
When an xDSL modem or a terminal adapter is  
connected directly to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
enter the DNS address provided by your ISP. If  
connected to a gateway (router), enter the IP address of  
the gateway.  
[
]/[ ] buttons to select Save Settings,and then  
press the [ ] button to save settings. After setting,  
saving data will take a few seconds. While saving data,  
be sure not to turn off the power, otherwise the data will  
be lost.  
When you are informed of a single DNS address, enter  
the address into e. 1st.If informed of two or more,  
enter one into f. 2nd.”  
MAC Address Sub-menu  
a. MAC Address  
Conrm the MAC address of your PC. You cannot  
change the MAC address.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Setup—Continued  
Client Sub-menu  
While the system sending information is called a server,  
the machine receiving the data is called a client.”  
Multiple clients can be connected to a single server.  
From the viewpoint of Net-Tune Central, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is a client.  
a. Client Name  
Conrm the client name used on the Net-Tune system.  
The client name is assigned by the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. You cannot change the assigned name.  
b. Wakeup on LAN  
Specify the network condition on standby of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
Enable: To be left connected.  
Disable: To be disconnected while the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E is on standby to save electricity.  
c. NTSP Port  
Specify the TCP/IP port to communicate with Net-Tune  
Central. This setting is to determine the port for  
intercommunication and needs to match the setting at  
Net-Tune Central. Do not change the port number  
unless absolutely necessary. Press the [ ]/[ ]/[ ]/  
[
] buttons to select numerics, and then press the  
[ENTER] button. When all numerics are entered, exit  
from the character entry mode.  
Note:  
When the settings are complete, press the [RETURN]  
button to return to the Network Setup menu. Use the  
[
]/[ ] buttons to select Save Settings,and then  
press the [ ] button to save settings described in  
Network Setupon pages 121 and 122. After setting,  
saving data will take a few seconds. While saving data,  
be sure not to turn off the power, otherwise the data will  
be lost.  
Specifications:  
Ethernet port: 10BASE-T  
File type: MP3, WMA, WAV  
(supports non-compression format and sampling  
frequency of 32 , 44.1, 48 kHz)  
(WMA les with contents protected cannot be played)  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lock/Version Setup  
The following sub-menus allow you to lock your settings or display the software version of the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Lock Setup Sub-menu  
a. Lock  
You can lock all of the setting menus to prevent settings  
from being changed by mistake.  
Locked: Powering on and off will resume the setting  
when it was locked, discarding any modication that  
was made after locking.  
Unlocked (Default): No lock on setting operations.  
Firmware Version Sub-menu  
This section deals with conrmation of the rmware  
version for each program curently installed in your  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E (No procedure is provided  
for updating the rmware).  
a. Master version  
Conrm the rmware version for the main program.  
b. i.LINK(IEEE1394) version  
Conrm the rmware version for i.LINK.  
c. Net-Tune version  
Conrm the rmware version for the Net-Tune  
program.  
d. HDMI version  
Conrm the rmware version for HDMI.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote  
Controller  
The RC-557M/558M remote controller is a useful tool  
DVD Mode  
that can operate not only the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
but also all the other components of your home theater. To  
operate any component other than the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E with the RC-557M/558M remote control-  
ler, press the [MODE] button and use the scroll wheel to  
select the component to operate. Before operating a digital  
component including satellite tuner, cable TV, VCR, and  
TV with the RC-557M/558M, you need to program the  
remote control codes of the operated digital component  
into the RC-557M/558M.  
There are two methods. One method is selecting the  
name of a different brand from the table, entering the  
setting number listed, and calling up the pre-program-  
ming code (See page 130). The other method is sending  
the commands from the other brands remote control  
directly into this remote controller (See page 136).  
DVD mode is used to control an Onkyo DVD player  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via  
To select DVD mode, press the [MODE] button, and  
then roll the scroll wheel until “DVD” appears on the  
display.  
.
Note:  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor [MODE] button  
is illuminated, rolling the scroll wheel changes the input  
source and remote controller mode simultaneously  
(when you enter the DVD mode, be sure that the LCD  
display shows DVDin both of the top and bottom  
lines).  
Scroll wheel  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the  
Connection  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
Connecting your  
recorder, DVD player, or cassette recorder to the  
-compatible Onkyo CD player, MD  
TV  
I
INPUT  
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via  
allows you to con-  
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
trol your system with the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es  
remote controller by pointing it at the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. Since you dont have to enter any special  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
#
codes, or do any programming,  
these components quickly and easily. See page 47 for con-  
nection information.  
allows you to control  
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
Note:  
MODE  
INPUT  
To use the  
function, you must make an  
connec-  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
tion and an analog RCA/phono connection between the  
AV component and your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
even if they are connected digitally.  
TV  
INPUT  
+
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
Press the [MODE] button.  
1
PREV  
CH  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
Roll the scroll wheel to select your favor-  
ite mode.  
2
When operating the Onkyo DVD player, select  
DVD.”  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
When operating the Onkyo CD player, select  
CD.”  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
REPEAT  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
When operating the Onkyo MD player, select  
MD.”  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST  
TO  
NE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
When operating the Onkyo cassette tape deck,  
press the scroll wheel to display AMP.”  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
Point the remote controller toward the  
3
front panel of the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E, and press the appropriate  
buttons for your operation.  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote Controller—Continued  
1ON button  
FREPEAT button  
This button is used to turn on the DVD player.  
This button is used to set the repeat playback func-  
tions.  
2STANDBY button  
GA-B button  
This button is used to set the DVD player to Standby.  
This button is used to set the AB repeat playback  
function.  
3Number/letter buttons  
These buttons are used to enter title, chapter, and  
track numbers and to enter times for locating spe-  
cic points in time.  
HOpen/Close [ ] button  
This button is used to open and close the disc tray.  
4MODE button  
ILIGHT button  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
the remote controller modes. Press this button rst,  
and then roll the scroll wheel until DVDappears  
on the display.  
This button is used to turn on or off the remote con-  
trollers illuminated buttons.  
JCLEAR button  
This button is used to cancel functions and to clear  
entered numbers.  
5TOP MENU button  
This button is used to select a DVDs top menu.  
KINPUT button  
6Up/Down/Left/Right [ ]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ] &  
ENTER buttons  
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
DVDappears on the display.  
These buttons are used to navigate DVD menus and  
the DVD players onscreen setup menus. The  
[ENTER] button is used to start playback of the  
selected menu title, chapter, or track and to conrm  
settings.  
LMENU button  
This button is used to select a DVDs menu.  
MVOL  
button  
This button is used to set the volume of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
7CH/DISC +/button  
This button is used to select discs on a DVD changer.  
NSETUP/GUIDE button  
8RETURN/EXIT button  
This button is used to access the DVD players  
onscreen setup menus.  
This button is used to exit the DVD players  
onscreen setup menu and to restart menu playback.  
OMUTING button  
9DISPLAY button  
This button is used to mute the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This function can be set only with  
the remote controller.  
This button is used to display information about the  
current disc, title, chapter, or track, including the  
elapsed time, remaining time, total time, and so on.  
PPlay [  
] button  
0Previous/Next [  
]/[  
] buttons  
This button is used to start DVD playback.  
The Previous [  
] button is used to select the pre-  
QStop [ ] button  
vious chapter or track. During playback it selects  
the beginning of the current chapter or track. The  
This button is used to stop DVD playback.  
RRANDOM button  
Next [  
] button is used to select the next chapter  
or track.  
This button is used with the random playback func-  
tion.  
AFR/FF [  
The FR [  
]/[  
] buttons  
SANGLE button  
] button is used to start fast reverse.  
] button is used to start fast forward.  
This button is used to select different camera angles.  
The FF [  
TLAST M button  
BPause [ ] button  
This button is used with the last memory function,  
which allows you to resume DVD playback from  
where you left off.  
This button is used to pause DVD playback.  
CStep/Slow [  
]/[  
] buttons  
These buttons are used for frame-by-frame play-  
back and slow-motion playback.  
UMEMORY button  
This button is used with the memory playback func-  
tion, which allows you to create a custom playlist of  
titles, chapters, or tracks.  
DSUBTITLE button  
This button is used to select subtitles.  
EAUDIO button  
VSEARCH button  
This button is used to select foreign language  
soundtracks and audio formats (e.g., Dolby Digital  
or DTS).  
This button is used to search for titles, chapters,  
tracks, and specic points in time.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote Controller—Continued  
Boxed numbers are for MiniDisc mode (See page 127).  
CD Mode  
1ON button  
CD mode is used to control an Onkyo CD player con-  
This button is used to set the CD player to On or  
Standby.  
nected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via  
. To  
select CD mode, press the [MODE] button, and then  
roll the scroll wheel until “CD” appears on the dis-  
play.  
2Number/letter buttons  
These buttons are used to enter track numbers.  
3MODE button  
Note:  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
the remote controller modes. Press this button rst,  
and then roll the scroll wheel until CDappears on  
the display.  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor [MODE] button  
is illuminated, rolling the scroll wheel changes the input  
source and remote controller mode simultaneously  
(when you enter the CD mode, be sure that the LCD  
display shows CDin both of the top and bottom  
lines).  
4CH/DISC +/button  
This button is used to select discs on a CD changer.  
5DISPLAY button  
Scroll wheel  
This button is used to display information about the  
current disc or track, including the elapsed time,  
remaining time, total time, and so on.  
6Previous/Next [  
]/[  
] buttons  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
The Previous [  
vious track. During playback it selects the begin-  
ning of the current track. The Next [  
used to select the next track.  
] button is used to select the pre-  
TV  
I
INPUT  
+
TV CH  
-
] button is  
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7FR/FF [  
The FR [  
]/[  
] buttons  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
] button is used to start fast reverse.  
] button is used to start fast forward.  
+
CLEAR  
10  
-- ---  
/
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
The FF [  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
8Pause [ ] button  
This button is used to pause CD playback.  
MACRO  
9REPEAT button  
MODE  
INPUT  
This button is used to set the repeat playback func-  
tions.  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
+
0Open/Close [ ] button  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
This button is used to open and close the disc tray.  
DISC  
-
ALIGHT button  
PREV  
CH  
This button is used to turn on or off the remote con-  
trollers illuminated buttons.  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
BCLEAR button  
This button is used to cancel functions and to clear  
entered numbers.  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
CINPUT button  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
REPEAT  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
CDappears on the display.  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
DVOL  
button  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
This button is used to set the volume of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
EMUTING button  
This button is used to mute the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This function can be set only with  
the remote controller.  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote Controller—Continued  
9REPEAT button  
FPlay [  
] button  
This button is used to set the repeat playback func-  
tions.  
This button is used to start CD playback.  
GStop [ ] button  
0Eject [ ] button  
This button is used to stop CD playback.  
This button is used to set eject the MiniDisc.  
HRANDOM button  
ALIGHT button  
This button is used with the random playback func-  
tion.  
This button is used to turn on or off the remote con-  
trollers illuminated buttons.  
IMEMORY button  
BCLEAR button  
This button is used with the memory playback func-  
tion, which allows you to create a custom playlist of  
tracks.  
This button is used to cancel functions and to clear  
entered numbers.  
CINPUT button  
MiniDisc Mode  
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
TAPE2appears on the display.  
MiniDisc mode is used to control an Onkyo MiniDisc  
recorder connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
DVOL  
button  
via  
. To select MiniDisc mode, press the [MODE]  
This button is used to set the volume of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
button, and then roll the scroll wheel until “MD”  
appears on the display.  
Note:  
EMUTING button  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor [MODE] button  
is illuminated, rolling the scroll wheel changes the input  
source and remote controller mode simultaneously  
(When you select TAPE2as the top line, MD”  
appears in the bottom line.)  
This button is used to mute the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This function can be set only with  
the remote controller.  
FPlay [  
] button  
This button is used to start MiniDisc playback.  
1ON button  
GStop [ ] button  
This button is used to set the MiniDisc recorder to  
On or Standby.  
This button is used to stop MiniDisc playback.  
HRANDOM button  
2Number/letter buttons  
This button is used with the random playback func-  
tion.  
These buttons are used to enter track numbers and  
to enter times for locating specic points in time.  
IMEMORY button  
3MODE button  
This button is used with the memory playback func-  
tion, which allows you to create a custom playlist of  
tracks.  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
the remote controller modes. Press this button rst,  
and then roll the scroll wheel until MDappears  
on the display.  
4DISPLAY button  
This button is used to display information about the  
current disc or track, including the elapsed time,  
remaining time, total time, and so on.  
5Previous/Next [  
]/[  
] buttons  
The Previous [  
] button is used to select the pre-  
vious track. During playback it selects the begin-  
ning of the current track. The Next [  
used to select the next track.  
] button is  
6FR/FF [  
The FR [  
]/[  
]buttons  
] button is used to start fast reverse.  
] button is used to start fast forward.  
The FF [  
7Pause [ ] button  
This button is used to pause MiniDisc playback.  
8REC [G] button  
This button is used to start MiniDisc recording.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Onkyo Products Using the Remote Controller—Continued  
1MODE button  
Tape Mode  
This button is used with the scroll wheel to select  
Tape mode is used to control an Onkyo cassette  
the remote controller modes. Press the scroll wheel  
recorder connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
until AMPappears on the display.  
via  
. To select Tape mode, press the scroll wheel,  
2Previous/Next [  
]/[  
] buttons  
placing your remote controller into “AMP” mode.  
The Previous [  
vious track. During playback it selects the begin-  
] button is used to select the pre-  
Note:  
While neither the [INPUT] button nor [MODE] button  
is illuminated, rolling the scroll wheel changes the input  
source and remote controller mode simultaneously  
(When you select TAPE1as the top line, AMP”  
appears in the bottom line.).  
ning of the current track. The Next [  
used to select the next track.  
] button is  
The Previous/Next [  
]/[  
] buttons may not  
work properly with some cassette tapes depending  
on how they were recorded.  
Scroll wheel  
3Rewind/FF [  
]/[  
] buttons  
The Rewind [  
] button is used to start rewind.  
The FF [  
] button is used to start fast forward.  
4REC [G] button  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
TV  
This button is used to start tape recording.  
I
INPUT  
5LIGHT button  
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
This button is used to turn on or off the remote con-  
trollers illuminated buttons.  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
8
9
6INPUT button  
PQRS  
TUV  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
This button is used to select the input source. Press  
this button rst, and then roll the scroll wheel until  
TAPE1appears on the display.  
#
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
MACRO  
7VOL  
button  
MODE  
INPUT  
This button is used to set the volume of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
INPUT  
8MUTING button  
+
This button is used to mute the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This function can be set only with  
the remote controller.  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
DISC  
-
PREV  
CH  
8Play [  
] button  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
This button is used to start tape playback.  
0Stop [ ] button  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
This button is used to stop tape playback.  
AReverse Play [  
] button  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
This button is used to start reverse playback.  
-
REPEAT  
A B  
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other  
Components  
You can use the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote  
Use the number buttons to enter  
the 4-digit remote control code.  
5
controller (RC-557M/558M) to control your other AV  
components, including those made by other manufac-  
turers. To do this you can:  
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
@.  
-
'/  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
Enter a remote control code for the component that  
you want to control (e.g., DVD, TV, VCR).  
Learn commands directly from the other components  
remote controller (see page 136).  
Use the Macro function to learn a sequence of actions  
(see page 137).  
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
0
If the code is accepted, the following  
appears on the display for a while, and  
then the normal display reappears.  
Entering a Remote Control Code  
By entering the appropriate remote control code for  
each of your components, you can control each compo-  
nent by selecting the relevant remote controller mode:  
DVD, TV, VCR, CBL (cable), or SAT (satellite).  
If the code is not accepted, after the  
message RETRYhas been displayed,  
the code entry display reappears, and  
you should try entering the code again.  
To cancel this procedure at any point,  
press the [CUSTOM] button.  
Look up the appropriate remote  
1
control code for the component.  
See Remote Control Codeson pages  
130-133.  
Select the remote controller mode,  
point the remote controller at the  
component, and check its opera-  
tion.  
The remote controller buttons that can  
be used in DVD mode are shown on  
page 124. Those that can be used with  
the TV, VCR, CBL, and SAT modes are  
listed on pages 134 and 135.  
6
Press and hold down the [CUS-  
TOM] button for more than three  
2
CUSTOM  
seconds.  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
PRGRM,and then press the  
3
Remote Control Codes for an Onkyo DVD player  
scroll wheel.  
The remote control code that you use with an Onkyo  
DVD player depends on whether its connected via  
as follows:  
,
5001: Use this code if youve connected an  
cable  
and an RCA/phono analog audio connection cable to  
your DVD player. This is the default setting, so if  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
4
youre using  
, you dont need to change it. Point  
the remote controller mode you  
want to use with the component,  
and then press the scroll wheel.  
The following remote controller modes  
can be selected: DVD, TV, VCR, CBL,  
or SAT.  
the remote controller at the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E to operate the DVD player.  
5002: Use this code if your DVD player doesnt have  
an  
socket, or youre not using  
. Point the  
remote controller at the DVD player to operate it.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Remote Control Codes  
SAT (satellite tuner)  
SAT (satellite tuner)  
Manufacturer  
Daewoo  
Diamond  
Dishnet  
Dual  
Control code  
Manufacturer  
Oceanic  
Octagon  
Okano  
Control code  
When two or more codes are given,  
try each one in turn, and choose the  
one that works best.  
4016, 4017, 4025  
4022  
4022  
4016, 4017  
4013  
4008  
4016  
Optex  
4015, 4023  
4016  
DVD (DVD player)  
Echostar  
Einhell  
Elta  
4010, 4018, 4025  
4013, 4017, 4025  
4015, 4017  
4025  
Orbit  
Manufacturer  
Aiwa  
Control code  
5010  
Orbitech  
Pace  
4017, 4019  
4012, 4026, 4031  
4022  
Akai  
5019  
Engel  
Pacific  
Apex  
5015, 5016  
5027  
Eurosat  
Eurosky  
Eurostar  
Fagor  
4013, 4022  
4013, 4024  
4024  
Palladium  
Palsat  
4013, 4017, 4021  
4019  
CyberHome  
Denon  
5017, 5020  
5003  
Panasonic  
Panda  
4006, 4031  
4024  
GE  
4015, 4023  
4012  
Hitachi  
5009  
Ferguson  
Fidelity  
Fracarro  
FTE  
Philips  
4021, 4029  
4015, 4023  
4017  
Integra  
5001, 5002  
5001, 5002  
5023  
4030  
Phonotrend  
Predki  
Integra Research  
JVC  
4017  
4025, 4030  
4017  
Premier  
Primestar  
Proscan  
Protek  
4023  
Kenwood  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
Mitsubishi  
Onkyo  
5017  
Fuba  
4007  
5004, 5021  
5025, 5026  
5005  
Galaxis  
GE  
4015, 4023  
4001, 4002  
4001, 4002  
4022  
General Instruments 4003  
Pye  
4021  
5001, 5002  
5011, 5017, 5020  
5004, 5021, 5028  
5006  
GMI  
4013  
Quelle  
4024  
Panasonic  
Philips  
Grundig  
Hinari  
4021, 4029, 4031  
4017  
Radix  
4035  
RCA  
4001, 4002  
4025  
Pioneer  
Proscan  
RCA  
Hirschmann  
Hitachi  
4019, 4035  
4036, 4037  
Roadster  
Rover  
5003  
4025  
5003  
Hughes Network  
Systems  
4014, 4020, 4024,  
4027  
4011  
Saba  
Sanyo  
5012  
Huth  
4013, 4015, 4024  
4014  
Samsung  
Satcom  
4017  
4024  
5007, 5013, 5018,  
5029  
Sony  
Imperial  
Intertronic  
Intervision  
Johansson  
JVC  
Technics  
Thomson  
Toshiba  
Xbox  
5020  
4013  
4017, 4020, 4027,  
4030  
SatPartner  
5022, 5024  
5008, 5021  
5022  
4015, 4023, 4024  
4015  
Schneider  
Sedea Electronique  
Seemann  
SEG  
4029  
4017  
4009, 4021  
4025  
4013  
Yamaha  
Zenith  
5020  
Kathrein  
Kolon  
4017, 4028  
4015, 4023  
4025, 4034  
4015  
5014, 5021  
4017  
Seleco  
K-SAT  
4025  
Skymaster  
Skyvision  
Sony  
SAT (satellite tuner)  
Kyostar  
Lasat  
4017  
4013, 4020, 4024  
4016, 4017, 4025  
4023  
Manufacturer  
Control code  
4005, 4031  
4016, 4017, 4020  
4013  
Lenco  
4014, 4017, 4025,  
4027  
Alba  
Strong  
Lennox  
Sunstar  
Techniland  
TechniSat  
Teco  
Allsat  
4015, 4027  
4022, 4025  
Loewe  
4013  
4015, 4023  
4019  
Alltech  
Lorenzen  
Macab  
4024  
4013, 4019, 4025,  
4030, 4031  
4022  
Amstrad  
4013, 4016  
4027  
Manhattan  
Maspro  
Matsui  
4015, 4020, 4023  
4021, 4025  
4021  
Anglo  
4025  
Teleciel  
Ankaro  
Anttron  
Apollo  
Arcon  
4025  
Telefunken  
Teleka  
4017  
4017  
4013  
Mediamarkt  
Medion  
Metronic  
Micro Technology  
Minerva  
Morgan’s  
Mysat  
4013  
4017  
Telemaster  
Telewire  
Tensai  
4020  
4025  
4016  
4015, 4023  
4016  
4013, 4017, 4020  
4025  
Armstrong  
Asat  
4013  
4016  
Thomson  
Thorens  
Tonna  
4024, 4025  
4022  
4021  
Astra  
4013, 4016, 4024  
4019, 4020  
4015  
4013, 4015, 4025  
4025  
Astro  
4015, 4023, 4025  
4004  
AudioTon  
Bush  
Toshiba  
Triasat  
4019, 4023, 4024,  
4025  
Neuhaus  
4012, 4014  
4024  
4019  
Condor  
Conrad  
Cosat  
Neusat  
Nikko  
4025  
Tristar  
4016  
4024  
4013, 4025, 4027  
4033  
Unisat  
4013  
4015, 4023  
4013  
Nokia  
Crown  
Nordmende  
4017, 4020  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
SAT (satellite tuner)  
VCR  
VCR  
Manufacturer  
Universum  
Vortec  
Control code  
Manufacturer  
Control code  
2012, 2046, 2047  
2003, 2004, 2022  
Manufacturer  
Control code  
4021, 4024  
4017  
Aiwa  
Akai  
Jensen  
2013  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2009,  
2032, 2035, 2040, 2048  
JVC  
Wela  
4025  
2033, 2041, 2044, 2045,  
2047  
Alba  
Kaisui  
Kendo  
Kenwood  
Kodak  
Loewe  
Logik  
2033  
Zehnder  
Zenith  
4020  
Anitech  
ASA  
2033  
2041, 2046  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2009  
2010  
4032  
2034  
Baird  
2036  
CBL (cable receiver)  
Bell & Howell  
Blaupunkt  
2007  
2028, 2034  
2028, 2043  
2030, 2031, 2036  
Manufacturer  
ABC  
Control code  
2039, 2042  
3001, 3002, 3021  
3006  
2033, 2041, 2044, 2045,  
2047  
Luxor  
Bush  
Archer  
2010, 2011, 2014, 2019,  
2020  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
Cabletime  
Cableview  
Contec  
3028, 3032  
3004  
Canon  
Carver  
Cimline  
Citizen  
Colortyme  
Craig  
2010, 2011  
2014  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2009,  
2010, 2014, 2031, 2034  
3009  
2033  
Matsui  
2028, 2041, 2046, 2047  
2010  
Eastern  
GE  
3010  
2008, 2009  
2005  
Matsushita  
3001, 3002  
3011  
2007, 2008, 2010, 2012,  
2019, 2030, 2036  
Gemini  
2008  
Memorex  
General Instruments 3002, 3022  
Crown  
2033  
Metz  
2039  
Grundig  
Hamlin  
Hitachi  
3031  
3012  
3002  
2001, 2005, 2008, 2009,  
2010, 2011, 2023, 2026  
Curtis Mathes  
MGA  
2022  
Minerva  
Minolta  
Mitsubishi  
Motorola  
MTC  
2039  
Cyrus  
2034  
2013, 2021  
2013, 2022, 2032, 2034  
2010  
Daewoo  
Dansai  
Decca  
2012  
3002, 3011, 3013, 3021,  
3022, 3023, 3026  
Jerrold  
2033  
Magnavox  
Memorex  
Movie Time  
NEC  
3014  
2034  
2008  
3015  
Dimensia  
Dumont  
Elcatech  
Emerson  
ESC  
2001, 2026  
2034, 2036, 2037  
2033  
Multitech  
2008, 2012, 2033  
3016  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2009,  
2032  
3003  
NEC  
Nokia  
3033  
2003, 2010, 2012, 2022  
2043  
Neckermann  
Nesco  
2034  
NSC  
3016  
2033  
Oak  
3009  
Ferguson  
Finlandia  
Finlux  
2035  
NOBLEX  
Nokia  
2008  
Panasonic  
Philips  
3020  
2034, 2036  
2034, 2036, 2037  
2033, 2041  
2007, 2030, 2036  
2004, 2010, 2024  
2012  
2030, 2036, 2043  
2048  
3007, 3008, 3014  
3017, 3024  
3001, 3002  
3004, 3020, 3022  
3006  
Nordmende  
Okano  
Pioneer  
Proscan  
RCA  
Firstline  
Fisher  
2046  
Olympus  
Optonica  
2010  
Fuji  
2017  
Realistic  
Sagem  
Salora  
Funai  
2028, 2041, 2045, 2046,  
2047  
Orion  
3034  
Garrard  
2012  
3029  
2001, 2002, 2008, 2010,  
2011, 2023, 2025, 2026  
Osaki  
2033  
GE  
Samsung  
Signature  
Sprucer  
3017  
Otto Versand  
Palladium  
Panasonic  
Pentax  
2034  
GEC  
2034  
3002  
2033  
GoldHand  
GoldStar  
Goodmans  
Gradiente  
Graetz  
2033  
3020  
2010, 2011, 2042  
2013, 2021, 2025, 2037  
2009  
2005, 2009  
2031, 2033  
2012  
Standard  
Component  
3018  
Pentex Research  
Philco  
Starcom  
Stargate  
Tele+1  
3011, 3021  
3011  
2010, 2011, 2014  
2036, 2043  
2030, 2034, 2036  
2033  
2010, 2014, 2017, 2034,  
2048  
Philips  
3030  
Granada  
Grandin  
Tocom  
3013  
Phonola  
Pioneer  
Proline  
2034  
United Cable  
Universal  
Videoway  
View Star  
Zenith  
3021, 3023  
3005, 3006  
3025  
2029, 2033, 2034, 2039,  
2040, 2042, 2044  
2006, 2013, 2032, 2034  
Grundig  
2044  
Harman Kardon  
HCM  
2005  
Proscan  
Pye  
2001, 2002, 2026  
2034  
2033, 2044  
3009, 3014, 3016  
3019  
2028, 2033, 2043, 2044,  
2047  
Hinari  
Quasar  
Quelle  
2010, 2011  
2034  
2013, 2021, 2025, 2028,  
2037, 2038, 2043  
Hitachi  
Radio Shack  
2017  
Ingersol  
Interfunk  
ITT  
2028  
Radio Shack/  
Realistic  
2007, 2008, 2010, 2011,  
2012, 2017  
2034  
Radiola  
2034  
2030, 2036, 2043, 2048  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2008,  
2010, 2011, 2013, 2014,  
2021  
JC Penney  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
VCR  
TV  
TV  
Manufacturer  
Control code  
Manufacturer  
Admiral  
Control code  
1026, 1040, 1062  
1002, 1067  
1045  
Manufacturer  
Control code  
2001, 2002, 2003, 2008,  
2010, 2013, 2021, 2023,  
2025, 2026, 2027  
1004, 1006, 1007, 1009,  
1010, 1017, 1025, 1027,  
1029, 1033, 1040, 1070  
RCA  
Emerson  
Akai  
Akura  
2007, 2008, 2010, 2011,  
2012, 2017  
Envision  
Erres  
1004, 1006  
1037  
Realistic  
Alba  
1035, 1043  
1063  
Rex  
2048  
Amplivision  
Amstrad  
Amtron  
Europhon  
Fidelity  
Finlux  
1067  
Roadstar  
Runco  
2033, 2043  
2019  
1035, 1067  
1009  
1068  
1039, 1040, 1067  
Saba  
2040, 2048  
2028, 2041  
2030  
Anam National  
Anitech  
1003, 1009  
1035  
1035, 1043, 1048, 1049,  
1063  
Firstline  
Fisher  
Saisho  
Salora  
AOC  
1004, 1005, 1006  
1066  
1010, 1017, 1052, 1063,  
1068  
Samsung  
Sansui  
Sanyo  
2008, 2043, 2049  
2006, 2032  
2007, 2008, 2030, 2036  
2047  
Arc en Ciel  
Arcam  
Formenti  
Frontech  
Fujitsu  
1040  
1063  
1045, 1062  
ASA  
1040  
1070  
Saville  
SBR  
Audiovox  
Autovox  
Baird  
1009  
Funai  
1009, 1045, 1048, 1070  
2034  
1040, 1068  
1069  
1001, 1003, 1004, 1006,  
1011, 1012, 1019, 1034  
Schaub Lorenz  
Schneider  
Scott  
2036  
GE  
2033, 2034  
2015  
Bang & Olufsen  
1040  
GEC  
1038, 1063, 1067, 1069  
1036, 1054, 1055, 1058,  
1059, 1068  
Baur  
Geloso  
Genexxa  
1035  
1062  
Sears  
2007, 2010, 2013, 2021  
2043  
Beko  
1052  
SEG  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1007,  
1008, 1025, 1047, 1063  
Bell & Howell  
Binatone  
1010, 1017  
1063  
GoldStar  
SEI  
2028, 2034  
2016, 2017, 2031  
2004, 2033, 2036  
2028  
Sharp  
Goodmans  
Gorenje  
Graetz  
1043, 1053, 1063  
1052  
1041, 1042, 1044, 1058,  
1059  
Shintom  
Shorai  
Blaupunkt  
1062, 1069  
1063, 1067  
Boots  
1063  
1040  
1040  
1048  
Siemens  
Singer  
2034, 2036, 2039  
2010  
Granada  
Brionvega  
Bruns  
1039, 1041, 1042, 1058,  
1059, 1064  
Grundig  
Sinudyne  
Sonolor  
Sony  
2028, 2034  
2030, 2031  
2004, 2018, 2024  
2010, 2021  
2046  
BSR  
Hallmark  
Hanseatic  
Hantarex  
HCM  
1004, 1006  
1060, 1068  
1067  
1035, 1043, 1048, 1050,  
1053, 1057  
Bush  
STS  
Cascade  
Celebrity  
Century  
Cimline  
1035  
1035  
Sunkai  
Sylvania  
Symphonic  
Tandy  
1002  
Hinari  
1035, 1043  
2010, 2011, 2012, 2014  
2012  
1040  
1004, 1006, 1007, 1013,  
1027, 1038, 1062, 1063,  
1069  
1035, 1043  
Hitachi  
2007  
1004, 1006, 1009, 1017,  
1022, 1025  
Citizen  
Tatung  
Teac  
2034  
Huanyu  
ICE  
1053  
Clatronic  
Colortyme  
Condor  
1052  
2012  
1045, 1063  
1052  
1004, 1006  
Technics  
Teknika  
Telefunken  
Thomson  
Thorn  
2010, 2042  
2010, 2012  
2048  
Imperial  
Infinity  
Inno Hit  
Interfunk  
Intervision  
ITT  
1052  
1014  
Contec  
1035  
1056, 1067  
1055, 1062, 1066, 1069  
1045, 1063  
1062, 1068, 1069  
1014  
Contec/Cony  
Continental Edison  
Craig  
1007, 1009  
2048  
1066  
2035, 2036  
1009  
2013, 2015, 2022, 2034,  
2048  
Toshiba  
Crosley  
1040  
JBL  
Totevision  
2008  
Crown  
1009, 1014, 1035, 1052  
1001, 1004, 1005, 1006,  
1011, 1012, 1016, 1019,  
1022, 1025, 1034  
Uher  
2043  
1001, 1004, 1006, 1010,  
1017, 1022, 1025, 1034  
JC Penney  
Curtis Mathes  
Daewoo  
Unitech  
2008  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1025,  
1035, 1053  
Jensen  
JVC  
1004, 1006  
Universum  
Vector Research  
Video Concepts  
2034, 2039, 2043  
2005, 2006  
2005, 2006, 2022  
1007, 1012, 1013, 1015,  
1033  
Daytron  
Decca  
1004, 1006, 1025, 1035  
1067  
Kaisui  
1035, 1063  
1062, 1069  
1060  
2008, 2010, 2012, 2013,  
2017, 2021, 2027  
Wards  
Dimensia  
Dixi  
1001, 1034  
1035  
Kapsch  
Kathrein  
Kawasho  
Kendo  
XR-1000  
Yamaha  
Yoko  
2010, 2012  
Dual  
1057, 1068  
1004, 1039, 1040  
1002  
1002, 1004, 1006  
1043  
2005, 2006, 2007, 2009  
2043  
Dumont  
Electroband  
Kenwood  
Kloss Novabeam  
Korting  
KTV  
1004, 1006, 1008  
1009  
Zenith  
2004, 2019, 2024  
1002, 1003, 1004, 1006,  
1008  
Electrohome  
Elta  
1040  
1035  
1009, 1025  
1005  
LG  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
TV  
TV  
TV  
Manufacturer  
Loewe  
Control code  
1014, 1040, 1055  
1004, 1006  
Manufacturer  
Pioneer  
Portland  
Price Club  
Prism  
Control code  
1004, 1006, 1027, 1062  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1025  
1022  
Manufacturer  
Siemens  
Control code  
1041, 1042, 1058, 1059  
1040  
Luxman  
Singer  
1001, 1006, 1010, 1014,  
1016, 1017, 1034  
1036, 1040, 1043, 1067,  
1068  
LXI  
Sinudyne  
1012  
M Electronic  
Magnadyne  
Magnafon  
1035, 1053, 1062, 1063  
1040, 1067, 1068  
1067  
Solavox  
Sonoko  
Sonolor  
1062  
1035  
1062  
Profex  
1035  
Proline  
1049  
Proscan  
Protech  
Proton  
1001, 1034  
1004, 1006, 1008, 1014,  
1018, 1020  
1002, 1030, 1032, 1036,  
1054  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
Matsui  
1035, 1045, 1063  
1004, 1006, 1007  
1037  
Sony  
1004, 1006, 1014, 1060  
Soundesign  
Starlite  
1004, 1006, 1009, 1070  
Pye  
1035, 1043, 1048, 1050,  
1063, 1064, 1067, 1068  
1009  
Quasar  
1003, 1012, 1031  
Stern  
1062  
Megatron  
Memorex  
1006  
1036, 1039, 1054, 1055,  
1058, 1059, 1068  
Quelle  
Sunkai  
1043, 1048, 1049, 1050  
1005, 1006, 1010, 1017,  
1035  
1004, 1006, 1008, 1014,  
1018, 1020  
Radio Shack  
1010, 1017, 1034  
Sylvania  
Metz  
1040, 1051, 1058  
1001, 1004, 1006, 1007,  
1009, 1010, 1017, 1021,  
1025  
Radio Shack/  
Realistic  
Symphonic  
Tandy  
1009, 1028  
MGA  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1008  
1039, 1058, 1059, 1064  
1026, 1062, 1063  
1038, 1063  
Minerva  
Radiola  
1037  
Tashiko  
Tatung  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1008,  
1040, 1055, 1058  
Mitsubishi  
Radiomarelli  
1040, 1067  
1003, 1063, 1067  
1063  
1001, 1003, 1004, 1005,  
1006, 1008, 1027, 1034  
Tec  
Mivar  
1047, 1056, 1067  
1003, 1026  
RCA  
Technics  
Techwood  
1012, 1044, 1061  
1004, 1006, 1012  
Motorola  
Realistic  
Rex  
1010, 1017, 1034  
1045, 1062  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1022,  
1055  
MTC  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1007,  
1009, 1022, 1025, 1031,  
1070  
RFT  
1040  
Teknika  
Multitech  
NAD  
1009, 1035  
Roadstar  
Saba  
1035, 1045  
1006, 1016  
Teleavia  
Telecaption  
Telefunken  
Teletech  
Teleton  
1066  
1040, 1062, 1066, 1069  
NEC  
1003, 1004, 1005, 1006  
1024  
1035, 1043, 1045, 1067,  
1068  
1040, 1041, 1054, 1059,  
1060  
Saisho  
Neckermann  
1066  
Salora  
1062  
1035  
Nikkai  
1045  
Sambers  
Sampo  
1056, 1067  
1004, 1006, 1025  
1063  
Nikko  
1006  
Tensai  
1048  
Oceanic  
Onwa  
1062  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1007,  
1008, 1022, 1025, 1035,  
1045, 1047, 1052, 1056,  
1060, 1063, 1065  
Thomson  
Thorn  
1066  
1009  
Samsung  
1054, 1055, 1058  
Optonica  
1021, 1026  
1010, 1016, 1017, 1022,  
1024, 1039  
1029, 1043, 1048, 1049,  
1050, 1067, 1068  
Toshiba  
Orion  
Osaki  
Sansui  
1029  
Totevision  
Triumph  
1025  
1045, 1063  
Sanyo  
1004, 1010, 1017  
1037, 1038  
1069  
1067  
1036, 1041, 1043, 1054,  
1055, 1058, 1059, 1060,  
1063  
SBR  
Otto Versand  
Palladium  
Panasonic  
Pathe Marconi  
Philco  
Universal  
Universum  
Voxson  
1011, 1019  
1045, 1052, 1058  
1040, 1062  
1063  
Schaub Lorenz  
Schneider  
1068  
1052  
1004, 1006, 1007, 1009,  
1070  
1003, 1012, 1014, 1031,  
1044, 1046, 1051, 1061,  
1062, 1069  
Scott  
Waltham  
1001, 1004, 1006, 1008,  
1010, 1015, 1016, 1017,  
1028, 1034, 1070  
1001, 1004, 1005, 1006,  
1008, 1011, 1014, 1018,  
1019, 1020, 1021, 1034,  
1070  
Sears  
1066  
Wards  
1003, 1004, 1005, 1006,  
1007, 1008, 1014, 1018,  
1040  
SEG  
1045, 1063  
Watt Radio  
Wega  
1068  
1036, 1040, 1048, 1067,  
1068  
SEI  
1040  
1003, 1004, 1007, 1008,  
1014, 1018, 1019, 1020,  
1037, 1038, 1040, 1053,  
1059, 1060  
Seleco  
Sharp  
1062  
Yamaha  
Yoko  
1004, 1005, 1006, 1008  
1045, 1063  
Philips  
1004, 1006, 1007, 1021,  
1023, 1025, 1026  
Zenith  
1004  
Phoenix  
Phonola  
1040  
Shorai  
Siarem  
1048  
1037, 1040  
1040, 1067  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Controlling a Satellite Tuner  
Controlling a VCR  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
TV  
ON,  
STANDBY  
ON,  
I
I
INPUT  
INPUT  
STANDBY  
+
TV CH  
-
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
1
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
Number  
buttons  
MNO  
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
TV VOL  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
+
-- ---  
/
CLEAR  
10  
0
10  
0
#
DIRECT TUNING  
#
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
Scroll wheel  
MACRO  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV  
TV  
INPUT  
INPUT  
ENTER  
+
+
CH  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
ENTER  
VOL  
CH/DISC +/–  
CH/DISC +/–  
DISC  
DISC  
VOL /  
VOL /  
-
-
PREV  
CH  
PREV  
CH  
/ /  
/
MUTING  
MUTING  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
REC  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
-
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
1. Roll the scroll wheel to select the input source  
and the remote controller mode for your satellite  
tuner.  
1. Roll the scroll wheel to select the input source  
and the remote controller mode for your VCR.  
Perform this operation while both the [MODE] and  
[INPUT] buttons are not illuminated. If you want to  
operate only the VCR without changing the input  
source, press the [MODE] button and roll the scroll  
wheel to select VCR.”  
2. Point the remote controller at your VCR, and use  
the following buttons (you must enter appropri-  
ate remote control code first).  
Perform this operation while both the [MODE] and  
[INPUT] buttons are not illuminated. If you want to  
operate only the satellite tuner without changing the  
input source, press the [MODE] button and roll the  
scroll wheel to select SAT.”  
2. Point the remote controller at your satellite  
tuner, and use the following buttons (you must  
enter appropriate remote control code first).  
ON, STANDBY  
Set the VCR to On or Standby  
Select TV channels  
Set the satellite tuner to On or  
Standby  
CH/DISC +/–  
ON, STANDBY  
Play  
CH/DISC +/–  
Select satellite channels  
Select menu items  
Stop  
/
/
/
ENTER  
Number buttons  
Confirm selection  
Enter numbers  
Rewind  
Fast forward  
The following buttons control the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Pause  
Record  
REC G  
Adjust the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
volume  
VOL  
The following buttons control the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
MUTING  
Mute the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Adjust the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
volume  
VOL  
MUTING  
Mute the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Controlling a TV  
Controlling a Cable Receiver  
ON  
1
STANDBY  
ON  
STANDBY  
TV  
TV  
ON,  
ON,  
I
I
INPUT  
INPUT  
*
STANDBY  
STANDBY  
+
TV CH  
-
+
TV CH  
-
2
ABC  
3
1
2
ABC  
3
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
@.  
-
'/  
DEF  
TV CH +/*  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
Number  
buttons  
Number  
buttons  
MNO  
MNO  
7
8
TUV  
9
7
8
TUV  
9
PQRS  
WXYZ  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
TV VOL  
TV VOL  
TV VOL / *  
+
10  
CLEAR  
+
10  
CLEAR  
0
0
#
#
DIRECT TUNING  
-- ---  
/
-- ---  
/
DIRECT TUNING  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM  
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
ZONE  
ZONE  
3
2
Scroll wheel  
Scroll wheel  
MACRO  
MACRO  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT  
MODE  
MODE  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
DIMMER  
SLEEP  
TV INPUT  
TV  
TV  
INPUT  
INPUT  
+
+
CH  
CH  
ENTER  
VOL  
ENTER  
VOL  
CH/DISC +/–  
CH/DISC +/–  
DISC  
DISC  
VOL /  
VOL /  
-
-
PREV  
CH  
PREV  
CH  
/ /  
/
MUTING  
MUTING  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
DISPLAY  
MUTING  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
REC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B RANDOM  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
AUDIO SUBTITLE ANGLE  
LAST M  
STEREO  
SURR  
THX  
A
LL ST  
SURR  
THX  
ALL ST  
-
-
B
REPEAT  
A
B
SEARCH MEMORY  
REPEAT  
A
SEARCH MEMORY  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
PURE  
A
DIRECT  
VIDEO  
DSP  
DSP  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
REPEAT  
MUSIC  
PHOTO  
-
+
-
+
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
TEST  
TONE  
CH SEL  
LEVEL  
LEVEL  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
PLAYLIST ALBUM  
AUDIO SEL  
ARTIST  
GENRE  
-
-
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
L
NIGHT  
Re EQ  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
CAPS  
DELETE LANGUAGE LOCATION  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
RC-557M  
RC-558M  
1. Roll the scroll wheel to select the input source  
and the remote controller mode for your TV.  
Perform this operation while both the [MODE] and  
[INPUT] buttons are not illuminated. If you want to  
operate only the TV without changing the input  
source, press the [MODE] button and roll the scroll  
wheel to select TV.”  
2. Point the remote controller at your TV, and use  
the following buttons (you must enter appropri-  
ate remote control code first).  
1. Roll the scroll wheel to select the input source  
and the remote controller mode for your cable  
receiver.  
Perform this operation while both the [MODE] and  
[INPUT] buttons are not illuminated. If you want to  
operate only the cable receiver without changing the  
input source, press the [MODE] button and roll the  
scroll wheel to select CBL.”  
2. Point the remote controller at your cable  
receiver, and use the following buttons (you must  
enter appropriate remote control code first).  
ON, STANDBY  
Set the TV to On or Standby  
TV on/off  
Set the cable receiver to On or  
Standby  
TV  
ON, STANDBY  
TV CH +/–  
Number buttons  
CH/DISC +/–  
TV INPUT  
Select TV channels  
Enter numbers  
CH/DISC +/–  
Select cable channels  
Enter numbers  
Number buttons  
Select cable channels  
Select TV or VCR input  
The following buttons control the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E.  
Adjust the TV volume  
TV VOL  
Adjust the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
volume  
*Buttons marked with an asterisk can always be used to control a  
TV regardless of the currently selected remote controller mode.  
These buttons do not work with the additional TV modes.  
The following buttons control the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
VOL  
MUTING  
Mute the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
Adjust the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
volume  
VOL  
MUTING  
Mute the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Learning Commands from Another  
Remote Controller  
Point the remote controllers at  
each other, about 2 to 6 inches (5–  
15 cm) apart, and then, on the  
other remote controller, press the  
button whose command you want  
to learn.  
When the command has been learned  
successfully, OKappears on the dis-  
play. You may need to press the button  
several times.  
5
You can teach the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote  
controller new commands simply by transmitting com-  
mands from another remote controller one at a time. For  
example, by transmitting the Play and Stop commands  
from your CD players remote controller, the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote controller can be  
taught to transmit those commands when its Play [  
]
and Stop [ ] buttons are pressed in CD mode.  
This is convenient when you want to add commands to  
buttons after entering a remote control code (See page  
129).  
If the command is not learned success-  
fully, after the message FAILhas been  
displayed, the mode select display reap-  
pears (step 3), and you should try again.  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
1
CUSTOM  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
To teach the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es remote controller  
more new commands, repeat  
steps 3 through 5.  
6
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
LEARN,and then press the  
2
scroll wheel.  
Press the [CUSTOM] button when  
youve nished.  
Notes:  
The following buttons cannot be taught new com-  
mands: [LIGHT], [CUSTOM], [MACRO], [MODE],  
[INPUT], [ZONE 2], [ZONE 3], and the scroll wheel  
button.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote controller  
can learn a total of 150 commands. However, the  
commands of some remote controllers may use a lot  
of memory, in which case, this total will be reduced.  
If the message FULLappears, the remote control-  
ler cannot learn any more commands because its  
memory is full.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
3
the remote controller mode you  
want to teach a new command,  
and then press the scroll wheel.  
By default, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote  
controller knows the commands for controlling an  
Onkyo CD player, cassette deck, DVD player, and  
MD recorder (e.g., Play, Stop, Pause, etc., buttons).  
You can teach these buttons new commands, although  
the defaults will be restored if the remote controller is  
reset.  
On the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es  
4
remote controller,press the button  
you want to teach the new com-  
mand.  
To teach a new command to a button that has already  
been taught a command, simply repeat this proce-  
dure.  
Like most remote controllers, the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es remote controller uses infrared.  
Commands from remote controllers that dont use  
infrared cannot be learned.  
If you press a button that cannot be  
taught a new command, the message  
RETRYappears and you should press  
another button.  
When the remote controllers batteries expire, all  
learned commands will be lost and will have to  
learned all over again, so dont discard your other  
remote controllers.  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Using Macros  
On the remote controller,press the  
buttons whose actions you want to  
program into the macro in the  
order you want them performed.  
To program the CD example in the left  
column into a macro: press the scroll  
wheel, press the [ON] button, roll the  
scroll wheel to select CD, press the  
scroll wheel, and then press the Play  
5
With the Macro function you can program the remote  
controller to perform a sequence of actions with one  
press of a button. For example, normally you need to  
perform the following actions to use a CD player thats  
connected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E:  
1. Press the scroll wheel, (to select AMP mode).  
2. Press the [ON] button (to turn on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E).  
[
] button.  
3. Roll the scroll wheel to select CD (to select the  
CD remote controller mode and the CD input  
source).  
Actions are numbered from 1 to 8.  
Macro #1 selected  
4. Press the Play [  
player).  
] button (to start the CD  
8 actions learned  
With the Macro function you can program the remote  
controller to do all of this with one press of a button.  
After each button is pressed, SETfol-  
lowed by KEYis displayed.  
Making Macros  
To add an action that selects an input  
source for the main room, Zone 2, or  
Zone 3, press the [INPUT], [ZONE 2],  
or [ZONE 3] button, respectively, roll  
the scroll wheel to select the input  
source, and then press the scroll wheel.  
You can make up to eight macros, and each macro can  
perform up to eight actions.  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
1
CUSTOM  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
When youve nished, press the  
Macro button.  
After the following appears on the dis-  
play, the display returns to normal.  
6
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MACRO,and then press the  
scroll wheel.  
2
MACRO  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
EDIT,and then press the scroll  
3
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select a  
macro, and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
4
Macros are numbered from 1 to 8.  
Macro #1 selected  
Action #1  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Remote Controller with Other Components—Continued  
Running Macros  
Roll the scroll wheel to select a  
character, and then press the  
scroll wheel to set it.  
The following characters are available.  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F G H I J K  
L M N O P Q R S T U V W XY Z + – = < >  
_ ¯¯ / \ * space  
5
Programmed macros can be run as follows.  
Press the [MACRO] button.  
1
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
macros number, and then press  
the scroll wheel.  
2
The actions in the macro are per-  
formed in the order in which they were  
programmed.  
Macro #1 selected  
1st character set  
Naming Macros  
Repeat step 5 until youve entered  
all 5 characters.  
The previous menu reappears.  
You can name your macros as follows. Names may con-  
tain of up to ve characters.  
6
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
If the name you are entering consists of  
less than ve characters, enter spaces at  
the end to the end to ll all ve places.  
1
CUSTOM  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MACRO,and then press the  
2
scroll wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
NAME,and then press the scroll  
3
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
4
number of the macro that you want  
to name, and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
Macro #1 selected  
1st character  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Settings for the Remote Controller  
Reordering the Remote Controller Modes  
Editing Remote Controller Modes  
You can change the order in which the remote controller  
modes appear when you roll the scroll wheel. The posi-  
tion of the AMP mode cannot be changed.  
Adding New Remote Controller Modes  
You can add additional modes (DVD, TV, VCR, CBL,  
SAT) to the remote controller. This is useful if, for  
example, you have several DVD players or TVs.  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
1
CUSTOM  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
1
CUSTOM  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MODE,and then press the scroll  
2
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MODE,and then press the scroll  
2
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
SORT,and then press the scroll  
3
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
ADD,and then press the scroll  
3
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
mode you want to move, and then  
press the scroll wheel.  
4
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
type of mode you want to add, and  
then press the scroll wheel.  
4
You can add up to 8 additional modes:  
for example, 4 DVD, 2 TV, 1 VCR, and  
1 CBL.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
5
mode before which you want to  
insert the specied mode, and  
then press the scroll wheel.  
Here the specied mode will be inserted  
before the VCRmode.  
If the move is successful, after OKhas  
been displayed, the SORT display (step  
3) reappears.  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Settings for the Remote Controller—Continued  
Deleting Remote Controller Modes  
Assigning Remote Controller Modes  
You can delete remote controller modes that you dont  
need, such as modes for components that you dont have.  
The AMP mode cannot be deleted.  
You can change the combination in selecting the input  
source and remote controller mode simultaneously  
using the scroll wheel. For example, when the input  
source (top) is TAPE1and the remote controller  
mode (bottom) is AMP,you can change only  
AMP(the remote controller mode) to CDR.”  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
1
ton for more than three seconds.  
CUSTOM  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
1
CUSTOM  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MODE,and then press the scroll  
2
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
MODE,and then press the scroll  
2
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
DEL,and then press the scroll  
3
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
ASSGN,and then press the  
3
scroll wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
mode you want to delete, and then  
press the scroll wheel.  
4
Roll the scroll wheel to select an  
input source, and then press the  
scroll wheel.  
4
If the mode is deleted successfully, after  
OKhas been displayed, the DEL dis-  
play (step 3) reappears.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
5
mode you want to assign to the  
specied input source, and then  
press the scroll wheel.  
If the assignment is successful, after  
OKhas been displayed, the ASSGN  
display (step 3) reappears.  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Settings for the Remote Controller—Continued  
Resetting the Remote Controller  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
1
You can reset the remote controller to its default set-  
tings.  
CUSTOM  
Press and hold the [CUSTOM] but-  
ton for more than three seconds.  
1
CUSTOM  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
SETUP,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
2
3
4
5
The remote controller enters Custom  
mode.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
SETUP,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
2
Roll the scroll wheel to select IR/  
RF,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
RESET,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
3
Roll the scroll wheel to select IR”  
or RF,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
When you select IR.”  
Roll the scroll wheel to select  
YES,and then press the scroll  
wheel.  
The remote controller is reset to its  
default settings.  
4
If you select RF,roll the scroll  
wheel to select the same ID as the  
RF receiver, and then press the  
scroll wheel.  
IDs 0 to 9 and A to F can be selected.  
Using the Remote Controller with  
Radio Frequency (RC-558M only)  
You can set the remote controllers transmission signal  
format to either infrared (IR) or radio frequency (RF).  
The default setting is IR.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select the  
same channel as the RF receiver,  
and then press the scroll wheel.  
Channels 0 to 3 can be selected.  
If the ID and channel have been set suc-  
cessfully, OKappears on the display.  
6
This is useful when, for example, the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E is installed in a rack or is not in line of  
sight of the remote controller as it allows you to use a  
commercially available RF receiver to pick up com-  
mands from the remote controller, which are then fed to  
the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E via its IR IN socket. For  
this to work, you must assign the same ID and channel  
to the remote controller and RF receiver.  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Settings for the Remote Controller—Continued  
Changing the Remote Controllers  
Control ID  
This section explains how to change the remote control-  
lers ID. You may need to change this if the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote controller inter-  
feres with other Onkyo components located in the same  
room.  
Note:  
If you change the remote controllers ID, be sure to  
select the same ID on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
For details on setting up the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000Es remote control ID, refer to the Remote  
Control Setup Sub-menusection on page 87. The  
default ID for both the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E and  
remote controller is 1.  
Hold down the remote controllers [CUS-  
TOM] button for more than three seconds.  
1
The remote controller enters Custom mode.  
Roll the scroll wheel to select SETUP”  
menu, and then press the scroll wheel.  
2
Roll the scroll wheel to select ID menu,  
and then press the scroll wheel.  
3
Roll the scroll wheel to select an  
ID1 (default), 2, or 3and then  
press the scroll wheel.  
4
Select the same ID as that set on the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E.  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relationship Between Input Source and Listening  
Mode  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital/AAC  
2ch 1/0  
AAC  
Analog Multichannel  
5.1ch 7.1ch  
Input Signal Format  
PCM  
Multichannel Multichannel  
1+1  
(*/2)  
(Other than  
*/2)  
Button  
CD, TV, LD,  
VHS, MD,  
Type of source  
DVD-Audio, Super  
Audio CD  
Vinyl, Radio,  
Cassette, Cable,  
Satellite, etc.  
DVD, Digital cable/sattellite, etc.  
Listening mode  
DIRECT Direct  
PURE A Pure Audio  
STEREO Stereo  
Multiplex  
• PLII Movie  
• PLII Music  
• PLII Game  
• PLIIx Movie  
• PLIIx Music  
• PLIIx Game  
Dolby Digital/AAC  
Dolby VS  
Dolby Digital EX/Dolby EX  
DTS  
DTS 96/24  
DTS-ES Discrete  
DTS-ES Matrix  
DTS NEO:6 (NEO:6 Matrix)  
• NEO:6 Cinema  
• NEO:6 Music  
Multichannel  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-  
Audio  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD  
THX • THX Cinema  
• THX Ultra2 Cinema  
• THX Music Mode  
• THX Games Mode  
• THX SurroundEX  
Mono  
All Ch Stereo  
Full Mono  
Mono Movie  
Enhance  
Orchestra  
Unplugged  
Studio-Mix  
TV Logic  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relationship Between Input Source and Listening Mode—Continued  
DTS  
DTS96/24  
Discrete/  
Matrix  
Input Signal Format  
Multichannel  
Multichannel Multichannel  
Multichanne  
l
2/0  
1/0  
Matrix  
2ch  
1/0  
(Otherthan  
*/2)  
(Otherthan  
*/2)  
(*/2)  
(*/2)  
Button  
Type of source  
Listening mode  
DVD, LD, CD, etc.  
DIRECT Direct  
PURE A Pure Audio  
STEREO Stereo  
Multiplex  
• PLII Movie  
• PLII Music  
• PLII Game  
• PLIIx Movie  
• PLIIx Music  
• PLIIx Game  
Dolby Digital/AAC  
Dolby VS  
Dolby Digital EX/Dolby EX  
DTS  
DTS 96/24  
DTS-ES Discrete  
DTS-ES Matrix  
DTS NEO:6 (NEO:6 Matrix)  
• NEO:6 Cinema  
• NEO:6 Music  
Multichannel  
*2  
*2  
*2  
*2  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-  
Audio  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD  
THX • THX Cinema  
• THX Ultra2 Cinema  
• THX Music Mode  
• THX Games Mode  
• THX SurroundEX  
Mono  
All Ch Stereo  
Full Mono  
Mono Movie  
Enhance  
Orchestra  
Unplugged  
Studio-Mix  
TV Logic  
*2 NEO:6-96k  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relationship Between Input Source and Listening Mode—Continued  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-Audio  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):  
SACD  
Input Signal Format  
Multichannel Multichannel  
2/0  
1/0  
1+1  
176.4/192 Multichannel  
2/0  
Button  
(*/2)  
(Other than  
*/2)  
kHz  
(3/2)  
Type of source  
Listening mode  
DVD-Audio  
Super Audio CD  
DIRECT Direct  
PURE A Pure Audio  
STEREO Stereo  
Multiplex  
• PLII Movie  
• PLII Music  
• PLII Game  
• PLIIx Movie  
• PLIIx Music  
• PLIIx Game  
Dolby Digital/AAC  
Dolby VS  
Dolby Digital EX/Dolby EX  
DTS  
DTS 96/24  
DTS-ES Discrete  
DTS-ES Matrix  
DTS NEO:6 (NEO:6 Matrix)  
• NEO:6 Cinema  
• NEO:6 Music  
Multichannel  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):DVD-  
Audio  
i.LINK(IEEE1394):SACD  
THX • THX Cinema  
• THX Ultra2 Cinema  
• THX Music Mode  
• THX Games Mode  
• THX SurroundEX  
Mono  
All Ch Stereo  
Full Mono  
Mono Movie  
Enhance  
Orchestra  
Unplugged  
Studio-Mix  
TV Logic  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
If you have any trouble using your TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E,  
look for a solution in this section. If you cant resolve the issue  
yourself, contact the dealer from whom you purchased this  
unit.  
Not all listening modes use all of the speakers.  
Specify the Speaker/Output Setup and Input Setup (pages  
88-98).  
Only the front speakers produce sound?  
When the Stereo listening mode is selected, only the front  
speakers and subwoofer produce sound.  
When the Direct or Pure Audio listening mode is selected,  
only the front speakers produce sound.  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (page 88).  
Power  
Cant turn on the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E?  
Make sure that the power cord is properly plugged into the  
wall outlet. (USA, Canadian, and Australian models: make  
sure that the other end of the power cord is properly con-  
nected to the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es AC INLET).  
Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet, wait ve sec-  
onds or more, then plug the cable in again.  
Only the center speaker produces sound?  
If you use the Pro Logic II/IIx Movie or Pro Logic II/IIx  
Music listening mode with a mono source, such as an AM  
radio station or mono TV program, the sound is concen-  
trated in the center speaker.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E turns off as soon as its  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (page 88).  
turned on?  
The surround speakers produce no sound?  
The amp protection circuit has been activated.  
When the Stereo, Direct, or Pure Audio listening mode is  
selected, the surround speakers produce no sound (page  
56).  
Depending on the source and current listening mode, not  
much sound may be produced by the surround speakers.  
Try selecting another listening mode.  
Remove the power cord from the wall outlet immediately  
and contact the dealer from whom you purchased this unit.  
The [STANDBY] indicator on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E remains lit?  
It is supposed that the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is using  
a source in Zone 2 or 3. When not using, set both Zone 2  
and 3 to Off(page 68).  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (page 88).  
The center speaker produces no sound?  
External devices connected to AC OUTLET of the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E do not turn off even when  
the unit is in standby mode.  
When the Stereo, Direct, or Pure Audio listening mode is  
selected, the center speaker produces no sound (page 56).  
When the listening mode is set to Mono,no sound can be  
present in the center speaker.  
It is supposed that the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is using  
devices in Zone 2 or 3. When not using, set both Zone 2  
and 3 to Off.”  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (page 88).  
The surround back speakers produce no sound?  
The surround back speakers are not used with all listening  
modes. Select another listening mode (page 56-58).  
Not much sound may be produced by the surround back  
speakers with some sources.  
If the SB Mode (5ch)is available in any sub-menu of the  
Listening Mode Setupmenu, make sure that it is not set  
to Off(pages 102-109).  
Audio  
Theres no sound, or its very quiet?  
Make sure that all audio connecting plugs are pushed in all  
the way.  
Make sure that the inputs and outputs of all components are  
connected properly (pages 88, 93).  
Make sure that the polarity of the speaker cables is correct  
and that the bare wires are in contact with the metal part of  
each speaker terminal (page 25).  
Make sure that the input source is properly selected (page  
50).  
Check the volume. It can be set from 81.5 to +18 (page  
50).  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is designed for home the-  
ater enjoyment. It has a wide volume range, allowing for  
precise adjustment.  
If the MUTING indicator is shown on the display, press the  
remote controllers [MUTING] button to unmute the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E (page 52).  
While a pair of headphones is connected to the PHONES  
jack, no sound is output by the speakers (page 52).  
Check the digital audio output setting on the connected  
device. On some games consoles, such as those that sup-  
port DVD, the default setting is off.  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (page 88).  
The subwoofer produces no sound?  
When you play source material that contains no informa-  
tion in the LFE channel, the subwoofer produces no sound.  
Make sure the speakers are congured correctly (pages 88,  
89).  
Theres no sound with a certain signal format?  
Check the input signal format setting. Depending on the  
playback source, you can select Auto, Multich, Analog, or  
i.LINK (page 55).  
Check the digital audio output setting on the connected  
device. On some games consoles, such as those that sup-  
port DVD, the default setting is off.  
With some DVD-Video discs, you need to select an audio  
output format from a menu.  
Depending on the input signal, some listening modes can-  
not be selected (page 143-145).  
Cant select the DTS-ES Discrete/Matrix or THX Sur-  
round EX listening modes?  
With some DVD-Video discs, you need to select an audio  
output format from a menu.  
These modes cannot be selected when no surround back  
speakers are connected, or Zone 2/3 is being used.  
If the SB Mode (5ch)is available in any sub-menu of the  
Listening Mode Setupmenu, make sure that it is not set  
to Off(pages 102-109).  
Make sure that the correct input signal audio format is  
selected with the [AUDIO SELECTOR] button (page 55).  
To use a turntable with an MC-type cartridge requires a  
commercially available MC phono preamp (page 38).  
Make sure that none of the connecting cables are bent,  
twisted, or damaged.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting—Continued  
Cant get 6.1 or 7.1 playback?  
Make sure that the proper setting is made for the OSD  
Setupsub-menu under the Preferencemenu (page 119).  
On your TV, make sure that the video input to which the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is connected is selected.  
If no surround back speakers are connected, or Zone 2/3 is  
being used, 6.1 and 7.1 playback is not possible.  
If the SB Mode (5ch)is available in any sub-menu of the  
Listening Mode Setupmenu, make sure that it is not set  
to Off(pages 102-109).  
Tuner  
The volume cannot be set above 99?  
Reception is noisy, FM stereo reception is noisy, or  
When the levels of all speakers have been calibrated (page  
the FM STEREO indicator doesnt appear?  
90), the maximum volume setting may change.  
Relocate your antenna.  
Move the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E away from your TV  
or computer.  
Noise can be heard?  
Using cable ties to bundle audio cables with power cords,  
speaker cables, and so on may degrade the audio perfor-  
mance, so dont do it.  
An audio cable may be picking up interference. Try reposi-  
tioning your cables.  
Press the [TUNING MODE] button to turn off the AUTO”  
indicator, bringing the FM mode to monaural (page 60).  
When listening to an AM station, operating the remote con-  
troller may cause noise.  
Passing cars and airplanes can cause interference.  
Concrete walls weaken radio signals.  
If nothing improves the reception, install an outdoor  
antenna.  
The Late Night function doesnt work?  
Make sure the source material is Dolby Digital (page 54).  
The multichannel input doesnt work?  
Check the MULTI-CH IN connections (page 64).  
Make sure that the multichannel input is assigned to the  
correct input source (page 64).  
When the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is unplugged or a  
power failure occurred:  
Set the audio input signal format to Multich (page 65).  
Normally, the built-in memory retains its contents for 2  
weeks. If it loses radio presets, make the presets again.  
About DTS signals  
When DTS program material ends and the DTS bitstream  
stops, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E remains in DTS lis-  
tening mode and the DTS indicator remains on. This is to  
prevent noise when you use the pause, fast forward, or fast  
reverse function on your player. If you switch your player  
from DTS to PCM, because the TX-NR1000/  
Remote Controller  
The remote controller doesnt work?  
Make sure that the batteries are installed with the correct  
polarity (page 9).  
Install new batteries. Dont mix different types of batteries  
or old and new batteries (page 9).  
TX-NR5000E does not switch formats immediately, you  
may not hear any sound, in which case you should stop  
your player for about three seconds, and then resume play-  
back.  
Make sure that the remote controller is not too far away  
from the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E, and that theres no  
obstruction between the remote controller and the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es remote control sensor (page  
9).  
Make sure that the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is not sub-  
jected to direct sunshine or inverter type uorescent lights.  
Relocate if necessary.  
If the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is installed in a rack or  
cabinet with colored glass doors, the remote controller may  
not work reliably when the doors are closed.  
Make sure youve selected the correct remote controller  
mode (pages 49).  
When using the remote controller to control other manufac-  
turersAV components, some buttons may not work as  
expected.  
With some CD and LD players, you wont be able to play-  
back DTS material properly even though your player is  
connected to a digital input on the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E. This is usually because the DTS bitstream  
has been processed (e.g., output level, sampling rate, or fre-  
quency response changed) and the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E doesnt recognize it as a genuine DTS sig-  
nal. In such cases, you may hear noise.  
When playing DTS program material, using the pause, fast  
forward, or fast reverse function on your player may pro-  
duce a short audible noise. This is not a malfunction.  
Video  
Theres no picture?  
Make sure youve entered the correct remote control ID.  
If you change the remote controllers transmission signal  
format to RF, be sure to select the same ID as the RF  
receiver.  
Make sure that all video connecting plugs are pushed in all  
the way.  
Make sure that each video component is properly con-  
nected.  
Make sure that the proper setting is made for the Video  
Assignsub-menu under the Input Setupmenu (page  
95).  
On your TV, make sure that the video input to which the  
TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E is connected is selected.  
While the Pure Audio listening mode is selected, the video  
circuits are turned off and the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E  
outputs no video signals.  
Cant control other components?  
If its an Onkyo component, make sure that the  
and analog audio cable (RCA/phono) are connected prop-  
erly. Connecting only an cable wont work (page 47).  
cable  
Make sure youve selected the correct remote controller  
mode (pages 47).  
The onscreen menus (OSD) dont appear, or they  
appear in an odd position?  
Make sure that the proper setting is made for the Video  
Output Assignsub-menu under the Speaker/Output  
Setupmenu (page 92).  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting—Continued  
Cant learn commands from other remote control-  
Cant get a list of Internet radio stations from the Xiva-  
lers?  
Net online database?  
Make sure that the transmitting ends of both remote con-  
Try again later.  
trollers are pointing at each other.  
Cant access music on the selected server, or cant  
Are you trying to learn from a remote controller that cannot  
be used for learning? Some commands cannot be learned,  
especially those that transmit several instructions with a  
single button press.  
connect to the server?  
Make sure that your computer is turned on and that Net-  
Tune Central is up and running.  
Add the MP3, WMA, and WAV les on your computer to  
the Net-Tune Central database. See the Net-Tune Central  
online help for details.  
Recording  
Set the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000Es POWER switch to  
OFF, wait ve seconds, and then set it to ON again (On  
USA, Canadian, and Australian models, disconnect the  
power cord for ve seconds, and then reconnect it). If that  
doesnt help, restart your computer.  
On the Client Sub-menu, make sure that the NTSP Port set-  
ting is set to the same port number as Net-Tune Central.  
Correct as necessary (page 122).  
Cant record?  
On your recorder, make sure the correct input is selected  
(e.g., digital or analog).  
Make sure that proper output settings are made for the con-  
nected devices. Settings are available in the Rec Outof  
the Audio Output Assignand Video Output Assign”  
sub-menus under the Speaker/Output Setupmenu (pages  
91, 92).  
Cant select albums?  
Use Net-Tune Central to add album names to your music  
les.  
Zone 2/Zone 3  
Cant select artists?  
Zone 2/3 has turned off?  
Use Net-Tune Central to add artist names to your music  
les.  
Cant select by genre?  
Use Net-Tune Central to add genre names to your music  
les.  
No playlists are available?  
Use Net-Tune Central to create some playlists.  
Was the Sleep function set? The Sleep function turns off  
Zone 2/3 as well as the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E. To set  
the Sleep function for Zone 2/3 only, see page 67.  
Theres no sound?  
Recording and Zone 3 operation uses the same circuit and  
therefore cannot be used at the same time. Make sure that  
proper settings are made for outputs. Setting is available in  
Zone 2 Outor Zone 3 Outof the Audio Output  
Assignand Video Output Assignsub-menus under the  
Speaker/Output Setupmenu (pages 91, 92).  
For other Net-Tune-related issues, please see the Net-Tune  
FAQ on the Onkyo Web site.  
The Surr Back speaker setting doesnt appear?  
Others  
If no surround back speakers are connected, or the sur-  
round back outputs are being used with Zone 2/3, this set-  
ting is unavailable.  
The sound changes when I connect my headphones?  
When a pair of headphones is connected, its listening mode  
changes depending on the mode that was set before it was  
connected.  
Net-Tune  
Cant change a setting?  
Some settings are not available while using Net-Tune.  
Cant use an audio adjust function?  
Some audio adjust functions cant be used with certain lis-  
tening modes.  
The display doesnt work?  
Cant access Internet radio or the Net-Tune server?  
Check the connection between the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E and the LAN port on your router or switch.  
Make sure that your modem and router are properly con-  
nected, and make sure they are both turned on.  
Make sure that the Network Setup settings are correct  
(page 121).  
The display is turned off when the Pure Audio listening  
mode is selected.  
Playback stops while listening to Net-Tune tracks?  
Make sure that your computer meets the system require-  
ments listed on page 72.  
When you download or copy large les on your computer,  
Net-Tune playback may be interrupted. In this case, try  
closing any unused programs, use a more powerful com-  
puter, or use a dedicated server computer for Net-Tune  
Central.  
If Net-Tune Central is serving WAV les to several clients  
at the same time, the network may become overloaded and  
playback may be interrupted. This can be resolved by pre-  
paring an Ethernet network exclusively for use with Net-  
Tune, separating it from general network trafc, and by  
using switches to improve network performance.  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting—Continued  
Error Messages  
Not available with Headphones use”  
Operation not allowed while a pair of headphones is con-  
nected.  
Not available in this Sp Cong”  
Doesnt work with the current speaker conguration.  
Only available with Dolby D”  
Can be used with only Dolby Digital.  
Not available with this signal”  
Doesnt work with the current listening mode.  
Not available with Muting”  
Operation not allowed because the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E is currently muted.  
Not available in this Listening Mode”  
Doesnt work with the current listening mode.  
Not available with NET AUDIO use”  
Operation not possible with Net Audio selected for the  
input source.  
Not available with Dolby Headphone Off”  
Doesnt work with the Dolby Headphone function off.  
Not available with Dolby Headphone On”  
Doesnt work with the Dolby Headphone function on.  
Not available with zone2 out in Line out”  
Operation not possible with 1-8.f. Zone 2 Outset to  
Line Out.”  
Not available with zone3 out in Line out”  
Operation not possible with 1-8.g. Zone 3 Outset to  
Line Out.”  
Memory backup  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E uses a battery-less memory backup system in order to retain radio presets and other  
settings when it is unplugged or in the case of a power failure. Although no batteries are required, the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E must be plugged into an AC outlet in order to charge the backup system.  
(On other than USA, Canadian, and Australian models, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E’s POWER switch must be set to  
ON in order to charge the backup system). Once it has been charged, the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E will retain the  
settings for several weeks, although this depends on the environment and time will be shorter in humid climates.  
The TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E contains a microcomputer for signal processing and control functions. In very rare situ-  
ations, severe interference, noise from an external source, or static electricity may cause it to lockup.In the unlikely event  
that this happens, unplug the power cord from the wall outlet, wait at least five seconds, and then plug it back in again.  
To reset the TX-NR1000/TX-NR5000E to its factory defaults, turn it on and, while holding down the [VIDEO 1] button,  
press the [STANDBY/ON] button. When the reset is complete, “CLEAR” appears on the display and the TX-NR1000/  
TX-NR5000E enters Standby mode.  
Onkyo is not responsible for damages (such as CD rental fees) due to unsuccessful recordings caused by the unit’s  
malfunction. Before you record important data, make sure that the material will be recorded correctly.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
General  
Miscellaneous  
IR out (1/8-inch mini-jack): 3 (for Main, Zone 2 and Zone 3)  
12V Trigger out (1/8-inch  
Power Supply Rating  
North American and some  
Asian models:  
European & Australian models:AC 230-240 V, 50 Hz  
Asian models:  
Consumption Power  
USA & Canadian models:  
European & Australian models:1,200 W  
Asian models: 1,200 W  
Standby Power Consumption: 3.9 W  
mini-jack):  
Inputs/Outputs:  
Miscellaneous  
i. LINK(AUDIO) (4 pin):  
Ethernet (Net-Tune):  
(1/8-inch mini-jack):  
RS232 (9 pin D-SUB  
Female connector):  
Antennas:  
5 (for A, B, C, D, E)  
AC 120 V, 60 Hz  
AC 220-230 volts, 50 Hz  
2
1
1
13.8 A  
1
Dimensions (W × H × D):  
435 × 220 × 480.5 mm  
FM:  
AM:  
75 ohms unbalanced  
Included loop antenna and external  
terminal  
(17 1/8" × 8 11/16" × 18 15/16)"  
Weight:  
Inputs:  
33 kg (72.8 lbs)  
AC Inlet:  
1 (IEC type)  
Audio  
AC Outlets:  
Multichannel (7.1ch) Inputs:2  
USA & Canadian models:  
Asian & Australian models: 1 (Switched, 100 W max.)  
1 (Switched, 120 W 1A max.)  
Phono (MM):  
Line inputs:  
1
9 (assignable), 1 (fixed) (Video 7  
on the front panel)  
6
Amplifier Section  
Digital inputs Coaxial:  
Digital inputs Optical:  
6 (assignable), 1 (fixed) (Video 7  
on the front panel)  
Power Output (All channels):  
USA & Canada (FTC):  
150 Watts per channel min. RMS  
into 8 ohms 2 channel driven,  
from 20 to 20,000 Hz with no  
more than 0.05% total harmonic  
distortion.  
200 Watts per channel min. RMS  
into 6 ohms 2 channel driven, 1,000  
Hz with no more than 0.1% total  
harmonic distortion.  
Video  
Composite Video inputs: 6 (assignable),  
1 (fixed, on the front panel)  
6 (assignable),  
S Video inputs:  
1 (fixed, on the front panel)  
Component Video RCA  
inputs:  
4 (USA & Canadian models),  
3 (others)  
Component Video BNC  
input:  
260 Watts per channel min. RMS  
into 8 ohms 2 channel driven,  
1,000 Hz with no more than 0.1%  
total harmonic distortion. [BTL]  
200 Watts per channel min. RMS  
into 6 ohms 2 channel driven, 1,000  
Hz DIN  
280 Watts per channel min. RMS  
into 8 ohms 2 channel driven, 1,000  
Hz DIN [BTL]  
1 (other than USA & Canadian  
models)  
Audio and Video  
HDMI inputs (19-pin):  
Miscellaneous  
2
Europe (DIN):  
3-IR in (1/8-inch mini-jack) for  
Main, Zone 2 and Zone 3  
Outputs:  
Audio  
Speakers A:  
Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R,  
Surround Back L/R  
Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R,  
Surround Back L/R or Powered  
Zone 2 L/R  
Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R,  
Surround Back L/R, Subwoofer  
Subwoofer  
Speakers B:  
Pre out A:  
Asia (JEITA):  
2 × 240 Watts into 6 ohms, 1,000  
Hz (EIAJ)  
2 × 350 Watts into 8 ohms, 1,000  
Hz (EIAJ) [BTL]  
Dynamic Power:  
Pre out B:  
Headphones:  
Line outputs:  
2 × 340 W (3 Ω, 2 channel driven)  
2 × 260 W (4 , 2 channel driven)  
2 × 175 W (8 , 2 channel driven)  
1
5 (assignable to Recout, Zone 2 out  
and Zone 3 out)  
2 (assignable to Recout, Zone 2 out  
and Zone 3 out)  
2 (assignable to Recout, Zone 2 out  
THD (Total Harmonic Distor-  
tion):  
Digital outputs Coaxial:  
Digital outputs Optical:  
Video  
0.05% (rated power)  
0.05% (1 watt output)  
60 at 8 ohms  
0.05% (rated power)  
0.05% (1 watt output)  
Damping Factor:  
IM Distortion:  
and Zone 3 out)  
Composite Video outputs: 3 (assignable to Monitor out A/B,  
Input Sensitivity and Impedance:  
Audio  
Recout, Zone 2 out and Zone 3 out)  
1 (fixed, Monitor out A)  
3 (assignable to Monitor out A/B  
and Recout)  
200 mV, 50 k(AUDIO IN 1-9/  
FRONT)  
S Video outputs:  
2.5 mV, 50 k(PHONO MM)  
200 mV, 50 k(MULTI IN FR/FL/  
C/SR/SL/SBR/SBL)  
36 mV, 50 k(MULTI IN SUB)  
0.5 Vp-p, 75 (DIGITAL IN  
COAXIAL 1-6)  
1 Vp-p, 75 (Composite Video)  
1 Vp-p, 75 (S Video, Y signal)  
0.28Vp-p, 75 (SVideo, C signal)  
1 Vp-p, 75 (Y)  
1 (fixed, Monitor out A)  
Component Video RCA  
outputs:  
2 (USA & Canadian models),  
1 (others)  
Component Video BNC  
output:  
Video (DVD, VIDEO 1-5)  
Component  
1 (other than USA & Canadian  
models)  
Audio and Video  
HDMI output (19-pin):  
1
0.7 Vp-p, 75 (PB/CB, PR/CR)  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specications—Continued  
AM  
Output Level and Impedance:  
Tuning frequency Range:  
USA & Canadian models:  
European & Australian models:522 to 1611 kHz, 9 kHz steps  
Audio  
AUDIO 1-5:  
530 to 1710 kHz, 10 kHz steps  
200 mV, 470 (Tape 1/2/ Video  
1/2/3 Rec Out)  
100 mV, 470 (Zone 2/3 Out  
(xed))  
1V, 470 (Zone 2/3 Out (variable))  
1 V, 470 (Front L/R, CENTER,  
SURR L/R, SURR BACK or  
Zone 2 L/R, SUB WOOFER)  
1 V, 470 (SUB WOOFER)  
Asian models:  
522 to 1611 kHz, 9 kHz steps or  
530 to 1710 kHz, 10 kHz steps  
*selectable  
30 µV  
40 dB  
40 dB  
40 dB  
0.7%  
Usable Sensitivity:  
Image Rejection Ratio:  
IF Rejection Ratio:  
S/N:  
PRE OUT A:  
PRE OUT B:  
Video  
VIDEO 1-4  
THD:  
Specications and features are subject to change without  
notice.  
(Composite Video):  
1 Vp-p 75 (Monitor Out A/B,  
Video 1/2/3 Rec Out, Zone 2/3  
Out)  
VIDEO 1-4  
(S Video, Y signal):  
1 Vp-p, 75 (Monitor Out A/B,  
Video 1/2/3 Rec Out)  
VIDEO 1-4  
(S Video, C signal):  
0.28 Vp-p, 75 ohms (Monitor Out  
A/B, Video 1/2/3 Rec Out)  
1 Vp-p, 75 ohms (Y)  
0.7 Vp-p, 75 ohms (PB/CB, PR/CR)  
120 mV RMS at 1,000 Hz, 0.5%  
THD  
COMPONENT VIDEO:  
Phono Overload:  
Frequency Response:  
Audio (CD in Direct mode) 5 Hz-100 kHz: +1/3 dB  
Video Component  
RIAA Deviation:  
Tone Control:  
10 Hz-50 MHz: +1/3 dB  
20-20 kHz: 0.8 dB  
12 dB at 50 Hz (Bass)  
12 dB at 1,000 Hz (Mid)  
12 dB at 20,000 Hz (Treble)  
80 dB (PHONO, IHF A, 5 mV  
input)  
S/N (Direct mode):  
95 dB (LINE, IHF A, 0.5V input)  
Due to setup menu  
Muting:  
Tuner Section  
FM  
Tuning frequency Range:  
USA & Canadian models:  
87.50 to 108.00 MHz, 200 kHz  
steps  
Other models:  
Usable Sensitivity:  
Stereo  
87.50 to 108.00 MHz, 50 kHz steps  
17.2 dBf, 2.0 µV (75 IHF)  
23 µV (75 DIN)  
11.2 dBf, 1.0 µV (75 IHF)  
0.9 µV (75 DIN)  
Mono  
50 dB Quieting Sensitivity:  
Mono  
Stereo  
Capture Ratio:  
Image Rejection Ratio:  
IF Rejection Ratio:  
S/N:  
17.2 dBf, 2.0 µV (75 ohms)  
37.2 dBf, 20.0 µV (75 ohms)  
2.0 dB  
85 dB (UDD, UDC: 40dB)  
90 dB  
Mono  
Stereo  
76 dB, IHF  
70 dB, IHF  
Alternate Channel Attenuation:  
Mono  
Selectivity:  
AM Suppression Ratio:  
Harmonic Distortion:  
Mono  
55 dB IHF  
50 dB DIN  
50 dB  
0.2%  
Stereo  
0.3%  
Frequency Response:  
Stereo Separation:  
30 to 15,000 Hz, +/1.0 dB  
45 dB at 1,000 Hz  
30 dB at 100 to 10,000 Hz  
17.2 dBf, 2.0 µV (75 )  
Stereo Threshold:  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sales & Product Planning Div. : 2-1, Nisshin-cho, Neyagawa-shi, OSAKA 572-8540, JAPAN  
Tel: 072-831-8023 Fax: 072-831-8124  
ONKYO U.S.A. CORPORATION  
18 Park Way, Upper Saddle River, N.J. 07458, U.S.A.  
Tel: 201-785-2600 Fax: 201-785-2650 http://www.onkyousa.com  
ONKYO EUROPE ELECTRONICS GmbH  
Liegnitzerstrasse 6, 82194 Groebenzell, GERMANY  
Tel: +49-8142-4401-0 Fax: +49-8142-4401-555 http://www.onkyo.net  
ONKYO EUROPE UK Office  
Suite 1, Gregories Court, Gregories Road, Beaconsfield, Buckinghamshire, HP9 1HQ  
UNITED KINGDOM Tel: +44-(0)1494-681515 Fax: +44(0)-1494-680452  
HOMEPAGE  
http://www.onkyo.com/  
ONKYO CHINA LIMITED  
Units 2102-2107, Metroplaza Tower I, 223 Hing Fong Road, Kwai Chung,  
N.T., HONG KONG Tel: 852-2429-3118 Fax: 852-2428-9039  
Printed in Japan  
D0409-1  
SN 29343668  
(C) Copyright 2004 ONKYO CORPORATION Japan. All rights reserved.  
* 2 9 3 4 3 6 6 8 *  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Ventilation Hood DA 5321 W User Manual
MTD Snow Blower E173 User Manual
Multiquip Heat Pump MP150SDLSM User Manual
Murray Lawn Mower 425001x99A User Manual
NEC Projector M300WS User Manual
Newcon Optik Hunting Equipment LRM 1500M User Manual
Numark Industries DJ Equipment DJ 24 User Manual
NuTone Fan GF1200N User Manual
Outlaw Audio Speaker ECS 10 User Manual
Panasonic CRT Television CT 27G6D User Manual